| % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files. |
| % |
| % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex. |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi |
| % |
| \def\texinfoversion{2014-12-03.16} |
| % |
| % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, |
| % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, |
| % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
| % |
| % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or |
| % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as |
| % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the |
| % License, or (at your option) any later version. |
| % |
| % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be |
| % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty |
| % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU |
| % General Public License for more details. |
| % |
| % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License |
| % along with this program. If not, see <https://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. |
| % |
| % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing |
| % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without |
| % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7 |
| % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3"). |
| % |
| % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug |
| % reports; you can get the latest version from: |
| % http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or |
| % http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or |
| % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page) |
| % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out |
| % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check. |
| % |
| % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a |
| % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the |
| % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated. |
| % |
| % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the |
| % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple |
| % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this: |
| % tex foo.texi |
| % texindex foo.?? |
| % tex foo.texi |
| % tex foo.texi |
| % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps. |
| % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct. |
| % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more |
| % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary. |
| % |
| % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some |
| % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the |
| % full Texinfo distribution. |
| % |
| % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo. |
| |
| |
| \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:} |
| |
| % If in a .fmt file, print the version number |
| % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because |
| % they might have appeared in the input file name. |
| \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}% |
| \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active} |
| |
| \chardef\other=12 |
| |
| % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo. |
| % For @tex, we can use \tabalign. |
| \let\+ = \relax |
| |
| % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine. |
| \let\ptexb=\b |
| \let\ptexbullet=\bullet |
| \let\ptexc=\c |
| \let\ptexcomma=\, |
| \let\ptexdot=\. |
| \let\ptexdots=\dots |
| \let\ptexend=\end |
| \let\ptexequiv=\equiv |
| \let\ptexexclam=\! |
| \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote |
| \let\ptexgtr=> |
| \let\ptexhat=^ |
| \let\ptexi=\i |
| \let\ptexindent=\indent |
| \let\ptexinsert=\insert |
| \let\ptexlbrace=\{ |
| \let\ptexless=< |
| \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite |
| \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent |
| \let\ptexplus=+ |
| \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright |
| \let\ptexrbrace=\} |
| \let\ptexslash=\/ |
| \let\ptexsp=\sp |
| \let\ptexstar=\* |
| \let\ptexsup=\sup |
| \let\ptext=\t |
| \let\ptextop=\top |
| {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode |
| |
| % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it |
| % starts a new line in the output. |
| \newlinechar = `^^J |
| |
| % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error |
| % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. |
| % |
| \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined |
| \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0. |
| \else |
| \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space} |
| \fi |
| |
| % Set up fixed words for English if not already set. |
| \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi |
| \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi |
| % |
| \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi |
| % |
| \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi |
| \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi |
| |
| % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful. |
| \chardef\spacecat = 10 |
| \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat} |
| |
| % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences. |
| \chardef\ampChar = `\& |
| \chardef\colonChar = `\: |
| \chardef\commaChar = `\, |
| \chardef\dashChar = `\- |
| \chardef\dotChar = `\. |
| \chardef\exclamChar= `\! |
| \chardef\hashChar = `\# |
| \chardef\lquoteChar= `\` |
| \chardef\questChar = `\? |
| \chardef\rquoteChar= `\' |
| \chardef\semiChar = `\; |
| \chardef\slashChar = `\/ |
| \chardef\underChar = `\_ |
| |
| % Ignore a token. |
| % |
| \def\gobble#1{} |
| |
| % The following is used inside several \edef's. |
| \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname} |
| |
| % Hyphenation fixes. |
| \hyphenation{ |
| Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script |
| ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps |
| data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script |
| man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm |
| par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces |
| spell-ing spell-ings |
| stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space |
| wide-spread wrap-around |
| } |
| |
| % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages. |
| \newdimen\bindingoffset |
| \newdimen\normaloffset |
| \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight |
| |
| % For a final copy, take out the rectangles |
| % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided |
| % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin). |
| % |
| \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt } |
| |
| % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file |
| % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here, |
| % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make |
| % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log |
| % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX. |
| % |
| \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}% |
| \def\loggingall{% |
| \tracingstats2 |
| \tracingpages1 |
| \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex |
| \tracingparagraphs1 |
| \tracingoutput1 |
| \tracingmacros2 |
| \tracingrestores1 |
| \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen |
| \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging |
| \tracingscantokens1 |
| \tracingifs1 |
| \tracinggroups1 |
| \tracingnesting2 |
| \tracingassigns1 |
| \fi |
| \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex |
| \errorcontextlines16 |
| }% |
| |
| % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things |
| % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message, |
| % after all. |
| % |
| \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg} |
| \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}} |
| |
| % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing |
| % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space. |
| % |
| \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount |
| \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi} |
| \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount |
| \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi} |
| \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount |
| \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi} |
| |
| % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks. |
| % |
| \newif\ifcropmarks |
| \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue |
| % |
| % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners. |
| % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986 |
| % |
| \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines |
| \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc |
| \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt |
| \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in |
| |
| % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor. |
| % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark. |
| % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark. |
| % |
| % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct. |
| % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase. |
| % |
| % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter |
| % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top |
| % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is |
| % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two |
| % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and |
| % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK... |
| \def\domark{% |
| \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}% |
| \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}% |
| \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}% |
| \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}% |
| \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}% |
| \mark{% |
| \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: top marks (\last...) |
| \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: bottom marks (default, \prev...) |
| \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks |
| }% |
| } |
| % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title |
| % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us |
| % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g., |
| % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very |
| % first @chapter. |
| \def\gettopheadingmarks{% |
| \ifcase0\topmark\fi |
| \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi |
| } |
| \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi} |
| \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi} |
| |
| % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors. |
| \def\lastchapterdefs{} |
| \def\lastsectiondefs{} |
| \def\prevchapterdefs{} |
| \def\prevsectiondefs{} |
| \def\lastcolordefs{} |
| |
| % Main output routine. |
| \chardef\PAGE = 255 |
| \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}} |
| |
| \newbox\headlinebox |
| \newbox\footlinebox |
| |
| % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents |
| % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself. |
| \def\onepageout#1{% |
| \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi |
| % |
| \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset |
| \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi |
| % |
| % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in |
| % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code). |
| \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \texinfochars} |
| % |
| \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi |
| \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}% |
| % |
| \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi |
| \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}% |
| % |
| {% |
| % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to |
| % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends |
| % before the \shipout runs. |
| % |
| \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output. |
| \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if |
| % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example. |
| % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this: |
| % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}} |
| % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in; |
| % it needs to be |
| % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym} |
| \shipout\vbox{% |
| % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page. |
| \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi |
| % |
| \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup |
| \hsize = \outerhsize |
| \vskip-\topandbottommargin |
| \vtop to0pt{% |
| \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}% |
| \nointerlineskip |
| \line{% |
| \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}% |
| \hfill |
| \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}% |
| }% |
| \vss}% |
| \vskip\topandbottommargin |
| \line\bgroup |
| \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize. |
| \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi |
| \vbox\bgroup |
| \fi |
| % |
| \unvbox\headlinebox |
| \pagebody{#1}% |
| \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt |
| % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty. |
| % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.) |
| % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect. |
| \vskip 24pt |
| \unvbox\footlinebox |
| \fi |
| % |
| \ifcropmarks |
| \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup |
| \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup |
| \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill |
| \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick |
| \vbox to0pt{\vss |
| \line{% |
| \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
| \hfill |
| \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}% |
| }% |
| \nointerlineskip |
| \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}% |
| }% |
| \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause |
| \fi |
| }% end of \shipout\vbox |
| }% end of group with \indexdummies |
| \advancepageno |
| \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi |
| } |
| |
| \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen |
| |
| \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}} |
| {\catcode`\@ =11 |
| \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi |
| % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala) |
| \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present |
| \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi |
| \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax |
| \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi |
| \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi} |
| } |
| |
| % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are |
| % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize |
| % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986) |
| % |
| \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong} |
| \def\nstop{\vbox |
| {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}} |
| \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong} |
| \def\nsbot{\vbox |
| {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}} |
| |
| % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of |
| % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a |
| % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument. |
| % |
| \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}} |
| \def\parseargusing#1#2{% |
| \def\argtorun{#2}% |
| \begingroup |
| \obeylines |
| \spaceisspace |
| #1% |
| \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below. |
| } |
| |
| {\obeylines % |
| \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{% |
| \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg. |
| \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm% |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment. |
| \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm} |
| \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm} |
| |
| % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space. |
| % |
| % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g., |
| % @end itemize @c foo |
| % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed |
| % by \finishparsearg. |
| % |
| \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M} |
| \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M} |
| \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{% |
| \def\temp{#3}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty |
| % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp: |
| \let\temp\finishparsearg |
| \else |
| \let\temp\argcheckspaces |
| \fi |
| % Put the space token in: |
| \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm |
| } |
| |
| % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so |
| % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation. |
| % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now, |
| % just before passing the control to \argtorun. |
| % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is |
| % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger |
| % that a pair of braces would be stripped. |
| % |
| % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token. |
| % |
| \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}} |
| |
| % \parseargdef\foo{...} |
| % is roughly equivalent to |
| % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo} |
| % \def\Xfoo#1{...} |
| % |
| % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my |
| % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03 |
| |
| \def\parseargdef#1{% |
| \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1% |
| } |
| \def\doparseargdef#1#2{% |
| \def#2{\parsearg#1}% |
| \def#1##1% |
| } |
| |
| % Several utility definitions with active space: |
| { |
| \obeyspaces |
| \gdef\obeyedspace{ } |
| |
| % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword |
| % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this |
| % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input |
| % should produce a line of output anyway. |
| % |
| \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie} |
| |
| % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces |
| % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the |
| % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ). |
| \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space} |
| } |
| |
| |
| \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next} |
| |
| % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this: |
| % |
| % \envdef\foo{...} |
| % \def\Efoo{...} |
| % |
| % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the |
| % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also |
| % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks |
| % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be |
| % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected. |
| % |
| % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they |
| % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The |
| % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this |
| % special case.) |
| |
| |
| % At run-time, environments start with this: |
| \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}} |
| % initialize |
| \let\thisenv\empty |
| |
| % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'': |
| \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} |
| \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}} |
| |
| % Check whether we're in the right environment: |
| \def\checkenv#1{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\thisenv\temp |
| \else |
| \badenverr |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Environment mismatch, #1 expected: |
| \def\badenverr{% |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp, |
| not \inenvironment\thisenv}% |
| } |
| \def\inenvironment#1{% |
| \ifx#1\empty |
| outside of any environment% |
| \else |
| in environment \expandafter\string#1% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo. |
| % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv |
| % |
| \parseargdef\end{% |
| \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname |
| \else |
| % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal. |
| \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname |
| \csname E#1\endcsname |
| \endgroup |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.} |
| |
| |
| % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space |
| % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space |
| % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and |
| % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the |
| % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph. |
| {\catcode`@ = 11 |
| % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble |
| % if the definition is written into an index file. |
| \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M |
| \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ } |
| } |
| |
| % @: forces normal size whitespace following. |
| \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 } |
| |
| % @* forces a line break. |
| \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces} |
| |
| % @/ allows a line break. |
| \let\/=\allowbreak |
| |
| % @. is an end-of-sentence period. |
| \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} |
| |
| % @! is an end-of-sentence bang. |
| \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} |
| |
| % @? is an end-of-sentence query. |
| \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space} |
| |
| % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation. |
| % |
| \def\onword{on} |
| \def\offword{off} |
| % |
| \parseargdef\frenchspacing{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing |
| \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the |
| % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would |
| % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph. |
| \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}} |
| |
| % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing |
| % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box |
| % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for |
| % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is |
| % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large, |
| % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and |
| % the text is small, which looks bad. |
| % |
| % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can |
| % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it |
| % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an |
| % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The |
| % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit |
| % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex). |
| % |
| \newbox\groupbox |
| \def\vfilllimit{0.7} |
| % |
| \envdef\group{% |
| \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else |
| \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp |
| \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}% |
| \fi |
| \startsavinginserts |
| % |
| \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup |
| % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as |
| % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an |
| % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after |
| % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group |
| % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo |
| % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text. |
| \comment |
| } |
| % |
| % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts |
| % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done) |
| % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space |
| % above. But it's pretty close. |
| \def\Egroup{% |
| % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group |
| % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth. |
| \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar. |
| \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth |
| \egroup % End the \vtop. |
| % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box. |
| \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox |
| % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less). |
| \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal |
| % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big |
| % group, force a page break. |
| \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2 |
| \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight |
| \page |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \box\groupbox |
| \prevdepth = \dimen1 |
| \checkinserts |
| } |
| % |
| % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help |
| % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'. |
| % |
| \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{% |
| group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J% |
| where each line of input produces a line of output.} |
| |
| % @need space-in-mils |
| % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining. |
| |
| \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in |
| |
| \parseargdef\need{% |
| % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a |
| % paragraph. |
| \par |
| % |
| % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless. |
| \dimen0 = #1\mil |
| \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox |
| \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox |
| \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2 |
| % |
| % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the |
| % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line. |
| % And a page break here is fine. |
| \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}% |
| % |
| % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the |
| % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the |
| % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider |
| % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the |
| % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999. |
| % |
| % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the |
| % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in |
| % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which |
| % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing |
| % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an |
| % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real |
| % document, then we can reconsider our strategy. |
| \penalty9999 |
| % |
| % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not. |
| \kern -#1\mil |
| % |
| % Do not allow a page break right after this kern. |
| \nobreak |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented). |
| |
| \let\br = \par |
| |
| % @page forces the start of a new page. |
| % |
| \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject} |
| |
| % @exdent text.... |
| % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin |
| |
| % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment. |
| % That's how much \exdent should take out. |
| \newskip\exdentamount |
| |
| % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun. |
| \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break} |
| |
| % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example. |
| \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount |
| \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}} |
| |
| % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current |
| % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion |
| % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual. |
| % |
| \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm |
| \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox} |
| % |
| \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{% |
| \nobreak |
| \kern-\strutdepth |
| \vtop to \strutdepth{% |
| \baselineskip=\strutdepth |
| \vss |
| % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to |
| % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size. |
| \ifx#1l% |
| \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}% |
| \else |
| \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}% |
| \fi |
| \null |
| }% |
| }} |
| \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l} |
| \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r} |
| % |
| % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]} |
| % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right; |
| % else use TEXT for both). |
| % |
| \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish} |
| \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing. |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
| \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
| \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts |
| \def\righttext{#2}% |
| \else |
| \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text |
| \def\righttext{#1}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| \ifodd\pageno |
| \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin |
| \else |
| \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}% |
| \fi |
| \temp |
| } |
| |
| % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should |
| % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the |
| % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would |
| % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main |
| % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command |
| % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work. |
| % |
| \def\|{% |
| % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode. |
| \leavevmode |
| % |
| % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output. |
| \vadjust{% |
| % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current |
| % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record. |
| \vskip-\baselineskip |
| % |
| % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So |
| % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin. |
| \llap{% |
| % |
| % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'. |
| \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt |
| % |
| % This is the space between the bar and the text. |
| \hskip 12pt |
| }% |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE. |
| % |
| \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz} |
| \def\includezzz#1{% |
| \pushthisfilestack |
| \def\thisfile{#1}% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE. |
| \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion |
| \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. |
| \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}% |
| \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }% |
| % |
| % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes |
| % definitions, etc. |
| \expandafter |
| }\temp |
| \popthisfilestack |
| } |
| \def\filenamecatcodes{% |
| \catcode`\\=\other |
| \catcode`~=\other |
| \catcode`^=\other |
| \catcode`_=\other |
| \catcode`|=\other |
| \catcode`<=\other |
| \catcode`>=\other |
| \catcode`+=\other |
| \catcode`-=\other |
| \catcode`\`=\other |
| \catcode`\'=\other |
| } |
| |
| \def\pushthisfilestack{% |
| \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm |
| } |
| \def\pushthisfilestackX{% |
| \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm |
| } |
| \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {% |
| \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}% |
| } |
| |
| \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty} |
| \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error: |
| the stack of filenames is empty.}} |
| % |
| \def\thisfile{} |
| |
| % @center line |
| % outputs that line, centered. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\center{% |
| \ifhmode |
| \let\centersub\centerH |
| \else |
| \let\centersub\centerV |
| \fi |
| \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}% |
| \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case |
| } |
| \def\centerH#1{{% |
| \hfil\break |
| \advance\hsize by -\leftskip |
| \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
| \line{#1}% |
| \break |
| }} |
| % |
| \newcount\centerpenalty |
| \def\centerV#1{% |
| % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if |
| % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe |
| % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still |
| % prevent a page break here. |
| \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty |
| \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi |
| \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi |
| \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}% |
| } |
| |
| % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space |
| % |
| \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip} |
| |
| % @comment ...line which is ignored... |
| % @c is the same as @comment |
| % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment |
| % |
| \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other% |
| \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other% |
| \commentxxx} |
| {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}} |
| % |
| \let\c=\comment |
| |
| % @paragraphindent NCHARS |
| % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough. |
| % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'. |
| % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though. |
| % |
| \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords |
| \def\noneword{none} |
| % |
| \parseargdef\paragraphindent{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\asisword |
| \else |
| \ifx\temp\noneword |
| \defaultparindent = 0pt |
| \else |
| \defaultparindent = #1em |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \parindent = \defaultparindent |
| } |
| |
| % @exampleindent NCHARS |
| % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent. |
| % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but |
| % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent. |
| \parseargdef\exampleindent{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\asisword |
| \else |
| \ifx\temp\noneword |
| \lispnarrowing = 0pt |
| \else |
| \lispnarrowing = #1em |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @firstparagraphindent WORD |
| % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph |
| % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such |
| % paragraphs. |
| % |
| % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling |
| % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do. |
| % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD. |
| % By default, we suppress indentation. |
| % |
| \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent} |
| \def\insertword{insert} |
| % |
| \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\noneword |
| \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent |
| \else\ifx\temp\insertword |
| \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to |
| % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty. |
| % |
| % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next |
| % paragraph. |
| % |
| \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{% |
| \gdef\indent {\restorefirstparagraphindent \indent}% |
| \gdef\noindent{\restorefirstparagraphindent \noindent}% |
| \global\everypar = {\kern -\parindent \restorefirstparagraphindent}% |
| } |
| % |
| \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{% |
| \global\let\indent = \ptexindent |
| \global\let\noindent = \ptexnoindent |
| \global\everypar = {}% |
| } |
| |
| |
| % @refill is a no-op. |
| \let\refill=\relax |
| |
| % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to |
| % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs. |
| % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename). |
| % |
| \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files. |
| \let\novalidate = \linksfalse |
| |
| % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file. |
| % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input. |
| % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo. |
| \def\setfilename{% |
| \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'. |
| \iflinks |
| \tryauxfile |
| % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit. |
| \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux |
| \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case. |
| \openindices |
| \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds. |
| % |
| % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it. |
| % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc. |
| \openin 1 texinfo.cnf |
| \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| % |
| \comment % Ignore the actual filename. |
| } |
| |
| % Called from \setfilename. |
| % |
| \def\openindices{% |
| \newindex{cp}% |
| \newcodeindex{fn}% |
| \newcodeindex{vr}% |
| \newcodeindex{tp}% |
| \newcodeindex{ky}% |
| \newcodeindex{pg}% |
| } |
| |
| % @bye. |
| \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend} |
| |
| |
| \message{pdf,} |
| % adobe `portable' document format |
| \newcount\tempnum |
| \newcount\lnkcount |
| \newtoks\filename |
| \newcount\filenamelength |
| \newcount\pgn |
| \newtoks\toksA |
| \newtoks\toksB |
| \newtoks\toksC |
| \newtoks\toksD |
| \newbox\boxA |
| \newcount\countA |
| \newif\ifpdf |
| \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest |
| |
| % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1 |
| % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined. |
| \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined |
| \else |
| \ifx\pdfoutput\relax |
| \else |
| \ifcase\pdfoutput |
| \else |
| \pdftrue |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| |
| % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets, |
| % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to |
| % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be |
| % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good. |
| % |
| % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and |
| % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user |
| % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so |
| % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to |
| % do this reliably, so we use it. |
| |
| % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements, |
| % which we \xdef. |
| \def\txiescapepdf#1{% |
| \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined |
| % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log? |
| % Many times it won't matter. |
| \else |
| % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses, |
| % backslashes, and other special chars. |
| \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images |
| with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot |
| be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI |
| output) for that.)} |
| |
| \ifpdf |
| % |
| % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex, |
| % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a |
| % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead |
| % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as |
| % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use |
| % black by default, though. |
| \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12} |
| \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0} |
| % |
| % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.); |
| % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s). |
| \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}} |
| % |
| % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly, |
| % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore. |
| \def\setcolor#1{% |
| \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}% |
| \domark |
| \pdfsetcolor{#1}% |
| } |
| % |
| \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack} |
| \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor} |
| \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor} |
| \def\lastcolordefs{} |
| % |
| \def\makefootline{% |
| \baselineskip24pt |
| \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}% |
| } |
| % |
| \def\makeheadline{% |
| \vbox to 0pt{% |
| \vskip-22.5pt |
| \line{% |
| \vbox to8.5pt{}% |
| % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks. |
| \getcolormarks |
| % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color. |
| \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}% |
| }% |
| \vss |
| }% |
| \nointerlineskip |
| } |
| % |
| % |
| \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines} |
| % |
| % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto). |
| \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{% |
| \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
| \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% |
| % |
| % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among |
| % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if |
| % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a |
| % bitmap. |
| \let\pdfimgext=\empty |
| \begingroup |
| \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1 |
| \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1 |
| \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1 |
| \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1 |
| \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1 |
| \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1 |
| \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp |
| \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}% |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}% |
| \fi |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}% |
| \fi |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}% |
| \fi |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}% |
| \fi |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}% |
| \fi |
| \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}% |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is |
| % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.) |
| \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
| \immediate\pdfimage |
| \else |
| \immediate\pdfximage |
| \fi |
| \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi |
| \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi |
| \ifnum\pdftexversion<13 |
| #1.\pdfimgext |
| \else |
| {#1.\pdfimgext}% |
| \fi |
| \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else |
| \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage |
| \fi} |
| % |
| \def\pdfmkdest#1{{% |
| % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters |
| % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title. |
| \indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \def\pdfdestname{#1}% |
| \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname |
| \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}% |
| }} |
| % |
| % used to mark target names; must be expandable. |
| \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1} |
| % |
| % by default, use black for everything. |
| \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack} |
| \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack} |
| \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink} |
| % |
| % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines |
| % come from Petr Olsak |
| \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0% |
| \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi} |
| \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax |
| \advance\tempnum by 1 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}} |
| % |
| % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the |
| % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number |
| % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text, |
| % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node. |
| % #4 is the page number |
| % |
| \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{% |
| % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the |
| % page number. We could generate a destination for the section |
| % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't |
| % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured. |
| \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}% |
| \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty |
| \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}% |
| \else |
| \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Also escape PDF chars in the display string. |
| \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}% |
| \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext |
| % |
| \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}% |
| } |
| % |
| \def\pdfmakeoutlines{% |
| \begingroup |
| % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline. |
| \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines |
| \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \def\thischapnum{##2}% |
| \def\thissecnum{0}% |
| \def\thissubsecnum{0}% |
| }% |
| \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}% |
| \def\thissecnum{##2}% |
| \def\thissubsecnum{0}% |
| }% |
| \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}% |
| \def\thissubsecnum{##2}% |
| }% |
| \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}% |
| }% |
| \def\thischapnum{0}% |
| \def\thissecnum{0}% |
| \def\thissubsecnum{0}% |
| % |
| % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et |
| % al. a second time, below. |
| \def\appentry{\numchapentry}% |
| \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}% |
| \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% |
| \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% |
| \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}% |
| \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}% |
| \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}% |
| \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}% |
| \readdatafile{toc}% |
| % |
| % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines. |
| % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of |
| % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above. |
| % |
| % We use the node names as the destinations. |
| \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
| \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
| \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% |
| \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}% |
| \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero |
| \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}% |
| % |
| % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of |
| % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters, |
| % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from |
| % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from |
| % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100. |
| % |
| % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to |
| % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too |
| % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents |
| % we use for the index sort strings. |
| % |
| \indexnofonts |
| \setupdatafile |
| % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike |
| % Texinfo index files. So set that up. |
| \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}% |
| \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}% |
| \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash |
| \input \tocreadfilename |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2 |
| \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other |
| \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]% |
| \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]% |
| ] |
| % |
| \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}% |
| \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax |
| \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces |
| \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}% |
| \advance\filenamelength by 1 |
| \fi |
| \nextsp} |
| \def\getfilename#1{% |
| \filenamelength=0 |
| % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get |
| % snagged on things like "@value{foo}". |
| \edef\temp{#1}% |
| \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax |
| } |
| \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 |
| \let \startlink \pdfannotlink |
| \else |
| \let \startlink \pdfstartlink |
| \fi |
| % make a live url in pdf output. |
| \def\pdfurl#1{% |
| \begingroup |
| % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not |
| % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context |
| % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one |
| % people have actually reported a problem with. |
| % |
| \normalturnoffactive |
| \def\@{@}% |
| \let\/=\empty |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just |
| % special-casing \var here? |
| \def\var##1{##1}% |
| % |
| \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}% |
| \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
| user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}% |
| \endgroup} |
| \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}} |
| \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks} |
| \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks} |
| \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}} |
| \def\maketoks{% |
| \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax |
| \ifx\first0\adn0 |
| \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3 |
| \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6 |
| \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9 |
| \else |
| \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi |
| \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else |
| \let\next=\maketoks |
| \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD} |
| \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi |
| \fi |
| \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
| \next} |
| \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}% |
| {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0} |
| \def\pdflink#1{% |
| \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}} |
| \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink} |
| \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st} |
| \else |
| % non-pdf mode |
| \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble |
| \let\pdfurl = \gobble |
| \let\endlink = \relax |
| \let\setcolor = \gobble |
| \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble |
| \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax |
| \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput |
| |
| |
| \message{fonts,} |
| |
| % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle. |
| % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in |
| % italics, not bold italics. |
| % |
| \def\setfontstyle#1{% |
| \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd. |
| \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font |
| } |
| |
| % Select #1 fonts with the current style. |
| % |
| \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname} |
| |
| \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}} |
| \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}} |
| \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}} |
| \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf} |
| \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}} |
| |
| % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since |
| % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh. |
| \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}} |
| |
| % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not. |
| % So we set up a \sf. |
| \newfam\sffam |
| \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}} |
| \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf. |
| |
| % We don't need math for this font style. |
| \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}} |
| |
| |
| % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size |
| % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers |
| % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined. |
| % |
| \def\lineskipfactor{.08333} |
| \def\strutheightpercent{.70833} |
| \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167} |
| % |
| % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this. |
| \def\baselinefactor{1} |
| % |
| \newdimen\textleading |
| \def\setleading#1{% |
| \dimen0 = #1\relax |
| \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0 |
| \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip |
| \normalbaselines |
| \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{% |
| \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip |
| depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap. |
| % |
| % do nothing with this by default. |
| \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble |
| \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble |
| \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble |
| |
| % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps. |
| % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run |
| % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.) |
| \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. |
| \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap |
| %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0) |
| %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0) |
| %%Version: 1.000 |
| %%EndComments |
| /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin |
| 12 dict begin |
| begincmap |
| /CIDSystemInfo |
| << /Registry (TeX) |
| /Ordering (OT1) |
| /Supplement 0 |
| >> def |
| /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def |
| /CMapType 2 def |
| 1 begincodespacerange |
| <00> <7F> |
| endcodespacerange |
| 8 beginbfrange |
| <00> <01> <0393> |
| <09> <0A> <03A8> |
| <23> <26> <0023> |
| <28> <3B> <0028> |
| <3F> <5B> <003F> |
| <5D> <5E> <005D> |
| <61> <7A> <0061> |
| <7B> <7C> <2013> |
| endbfrange |
| 40 beginbfchar |
| <02> <0398> |
| <03> <039B> |
| <04> <039E> |
| <05> <03A0> |
| <06> <03A3> |
| <07> <03D2> |
| <08> <03A6> |
| <0B> <00660066> |
| <0C> <00660069> |
| <0D> <0066006C> |
| <0E> <006600660069> |
| <0F> <00660066006C> |
| <10> <0131> |
| <11> <0237> |
| <12> <0060> |
| <13> <00B4> |
| <14> <02C7> |
| <15> <02D8> |
| <16> <00AF> |
| <17> <02DA> |
| <18> <00B8> |
| <19> <00DF> |
| <1A> <00E6> |
| <1B> <0153> |
| <1C> <00F8> |
| <1D> <00C6> |
| <1E> <0152> |
| <1F> <00D8> |
| <21> <0021> |
| <22> <201D> |
| <27> <2019> |
| <3C> <00A1> |
| <3D> <003D> |
| <3E> <00BF> |
| <5C> <201C> |
| <5F> <02D9> |
| <60> <2018> |
| <7D> <02DD> |
| <7E> <007E> |
| <7F> <00A8> |
| endbfchar |
| endcmap |
| CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop |
| end |
| end |
| %%EndResource |
| %%EOF |
| }\endgroup |
| \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{% |
| \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% |
| }% |
| % |
| % \cmapOT1IT |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. |
| \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap |
| %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0) |
| %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0) |
| %%Version: 1.000 |
| %%EndComments |
| /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin |
| 12 dict begin |
| begincmap |
| /CIDSystemInfo |
| << /Registry (TeX) |
| /Ordering (OT1IT) |
| /Supplement 0 |
| >> def |
| /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def |
| /CMapType 2 def |
| 1 begincodespacerange |
| <00> <7F> |
| endcodespacerange |
| 8 beginbfrange |
| <00> <01> <0393> |
| <09> <0A> <03A8> |
| <25> <26> <0025> |
| <28> <3B> <0028> |
| <3F> <5B> <003F> |
| <5D> <5E> <005D> |
| <61> <7A> <0061> |
| <7B> <7C> <2013> |
| endbfrange |
| 42 beginbfchar |
| <02> <0398> |
| <03> <039B> |
| <04> <039E> |
| <05> <03A0> |
| <06> <03A3> |
| <07> <03D2> |
| <08> <03A6> |
| <0B> <00660066> |
| <0C> <00660069> |
| <0D> <0066006C> |
| <0E> <006600660069> |
| <0F> <00660066006C> |
| <10> <0131> |
| <11> <0237> |
| <12> <0060> |
| <13> <00B4> |
| <14> <02C7> |
| <15> <02D8> |
| <16> <00AF> |
| <17> <02DA> |
| <18> <00B8> |
| <19> <00DF> |
| <1A> <00E6> |
| <1B> <0153> |
| <1C> <00F8> |
| <1D> <00C6> |
| <1E> <0152> |
| <1F> <00D8> |
| <21> <0021> |
| <22> <201D> |
| <23> <0023> |
| <24> <00A3> |
| <27> <2019> |
| <3C> <00A1> |
| <3D> <003D> |
| <3E> <00BF> |
| <5C> <201C> |
| <5F> <02D9> |
| <60> <2018> |
| <7D> <02DD> |
| <7E> <007E> |
| <7F> <00A8> |
| endbfchar |
| endcmap |
| CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop |
| end |
| end |
| %%EndResource |
| %%EOF |
| }\endgroup |
| \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{% |
| \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% |
| }% |
| % |
| % \cmapOT1TT |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char. |
| \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap |
| %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit) |
| %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0) |
| %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0) |
| %%Version: 1.000 |
| %%EndComments |
| /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin |
| 12 dict begin |
| begincmap |
| /CIDSystemInfo |
| << /Registry (TeX) |
| /Ordering (OT1TT) |
| /Supplement 0 |
| >> def |
| /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def |
| /CMapType 2 def |
| 1 begincodespacerange |
| <00> <7F> |
| endcodespacerange |
| 5 beginbfrange |
| <00> <01> <0393> |
| <09> <0A> <03A8> |
| <21> <26> <0021> |
| <28> <5F> <0028> |
| <61> <7E> <0061> |
| endbfrange |
| 32 beginbfchar |
| <02> <0398> |
| <03> <039B> |
| <04> <039E> |
| <05> <03A0> |
| <06> <03A3> |
| <07> <03D2> |
| <08> <03A6> |
| <0B> <2191> |
| <0C> <2193> |
| <0D> <0027> |
| <0E> <00A1> |
| <0F> <00BF> |
| <10> <0131> |
| <11> <0237> |
| <12> <0060> |
| <13> <00B4> |
| <14> <02C7> |
| <15> <02D8> |
| <16> <00AF> |
| <17> <02DA> |
| <18> <00B8> |
| <19> <00DF> |
| <1A> <00E6> |
| <1B> <0153> |
| <1C> <00F8> |
| <1D> <00C6> |
| <1E> <0152> |
| <1F> <00D8> |
| <20> <2423> |
| <27> <2019> |
| <60> <2018> |
| <7F> <00A8> |
| endbfchar |
| endcmap |
| CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop |
| end |
| end |
| %%EndResource |
| %%EOF |
| }\endgroup |
| \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{% |
| \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}% |
| }% |
| \fi\fi |
| |
| |
| % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2. |
| % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap |
| % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit). |
| % Example: |
| % #1 = \textrm |
| % #2 = \rmshape |
| % #3 = 10 |
| % #4 = \mainmagstep |
| % #5 = OT1 |
| % |
| \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{% |
| \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4 |
| \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1% |
| } |
| % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty. |
| \let\cmap\gobble |
| % |
| % (end of cmaps) |
| |
| % Use cm as the default font prefix. |
| % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix |
| % before you read in texinfo.tex. |
| \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined |
| \def\fontprefix{cm} |
| \fi |
| % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM. |
| \def\rmshape{r} |
| \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold |
| \def\bfshape{b} |
| \def\bxshape{bx} |
| \def\ttshape{tt} |
| \def\ttbshape{tt} |
| \def\ttslshape{sltt} |
| \def\itshape{ti} |
| \def\itbshape{bxti} |
| \def\slshape{sl} |
| \def\slbshape{bxsl} |
| \def\sfshape{ss} |
| \def\sfbshape{ss} |
| \def\scshape{csc} |
| \def\scbshape{csc} |
| |
| % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.) |
| % |
| \def\definetextfontsizexi{% |
| % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1). |
| \def\textnominalsize{11pt} |
| \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf} |
| \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} |
| \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep |
| \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep |
| \def\textecsize{1095} |
| |
| % A few fonts for @defun names and args. |
| \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} |
| \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} |
| |
| % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). |
| \def\smallnominalsize{9pt} |
| \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} |
| \font\smalli=cmmi9 |
| \font\smallsy=cmsy9 |
| \def\smallecsize{0900} |
| |
| % Fonts for small examples (8pt). |
| \def\smallernominalsize{8pt} |
| \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} |
| \font\smalleri=cmmi8 |
| \font\smallersy=cmsy8 |
| \def\smallerecsize{0800} |
| |
| % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): |
| \def\titlenominalsize{20pt} |
| \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} |
| \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} |
| \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \let\titlebf=\titlerm |
| \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} |
| \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 |
| \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 |
| \def\titleecsize{2074} |
| |
| % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt). |
| \def\chapnominalsize{17pt} |
| \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1} |
| \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} |
| \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1} |
| \let\chapbf=\chaprm |
| \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1} |
| \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2 |
| \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3 |
| \def\chapecsize{1728} |
| |
| % Section fonts (14.4pt). |
| \def\secnominalsize{14pt} |
| \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} |
| \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \let\secbf\secrm |
| \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} |
| \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 |
| \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 |
| \def\sececsize{1440} |
| |
| % Subsection fonts (13.15pt). |
| \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt} |
| \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} |
| \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} |
| \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1} |
| \let\ssecbf\ssecrm |
| \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1} |
| \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf |
| \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315 |
| \def\ssececsize{1200} |
| |
| % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt). |
| \def\reducednominalsize{10pt} |
| \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \font\reducedi=cmmi10 |
| \font\reducedsy=cmsy10 |
| \def\reducedecsize{1000} |
| |
| \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM |
| \textfonts % reset the current fonts |
| \rm |
| } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi |
| |
| |
| % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with |
| % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU |
| % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the |
| % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt. |
| % |
| \def\definetextfontsizex{% |
| % Text fonts (10pt). |
| \def\textnominalsize{10pt} |
| \edef\mainmagstep{1000} |
| \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1} |
| \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT} |
| \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep |
| \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep |
| \def\textecsize{1000} |
| |
| % A few fonts for @defun names and args. |
| \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1} |
| \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT} |
| \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf} |
| |
| % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt). |
| \def\smallnominalsize{9pt} |
| \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} |
| \font\smalli=cmmi9 |
| \font\smallsy=cmsy9 |
| \def\smallecsize{0900} |
| |
| % Fonts for small examples (8pt). |
| \def\smallernominalsize{8pt} |
| \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1} |
| \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT} |
| \font\smalleri=cmmi8 |
| \font\smallersy=cmsy8 |
| \def\smallerecsize{0800} |
| |
| % Fonts for title page (20.4pt): |
| \def\titlenominalsize{20pt} |
| \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1} |
| \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} |
| \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \let\titlebf=\titlerm |
| \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1} |
| \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3 |
| \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4 |
| \def\titleecsize{2074} |
| |
| % Chapter fonts (14.4pt). |
| \def\chapnominalsize{14pt} |
| \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} |
| \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \let\chapbf\chaprm |
| \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1} |
| \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1 |
| \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2 |
| \def\chapecsize{1440} |
| |
| % Section fonts (12pt). |
| \def\secnominalsize{12pt} |
| \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1} |
| \let\secbf\secrm |
| \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} |
| \font\seci=cmmi12 |
| \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1 |
| \def\sececsize{1200} |
| |
| % Subsection fonts (10pt). |
| \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt} |
| \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \let\ssecbf\ssecrm |
| \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1} |
| \font\sseci=cmmi10 |
| \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 |
| \def\ssececsize{1000} |
| |
| % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt). |
| \def\reducednominalsize{9pt} |
| \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT} |
| \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1} |
| \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT} |
| \font\reducedi=cmmi9 |
| \font\reducedsy=cmsy9 |
| \def\reducedecsize{0900} |
| |
| \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs |
| \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM |
| \textfonts % reset the current fonts |
| \rm |
| } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex |
| |
| |
| % We provide the user-level command |
| % @fonttextsize 10 |
| % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed. |
| % |
| \def\xiword{11} |
| \def\xword{10} |
| \def\xwordpt{10pt} |
| % |
| \parseargdef\fonttextsize{% |
| \def\textsizearg{#1}% |
| %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}% |
| % |
| % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since |
| % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless. |
| % |
| \begingroup \globaldefs=1 |
| \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex |
| \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi |
| \else |
| \errhelp=\EMsimple |
| \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'} |
| \fi\fi |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| |
| % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters, |
| % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. We don't |
| % bother to reset \scriptfont and \scriptscriptfont; awaiting user need. |
| % |
| \def\resetmathfonts{% |
| \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy |
| \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf |
| \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf |
| } |
| |
| % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead |
| % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the |
| % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire |
| % \tenSTYLE to set the current font. |
| % |
| % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower) |
| % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used |
| % in, e.g., the LaTeX logo and acronyms. |
| % |
| % This all needs generalizing, badly. |
| % |
| \def\textfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl |
| \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc |
| \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\textttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{text}% |
| \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}} |
| \def\titlefonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl |
| \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc |
| \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy |
| \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl |
| \def\curfontsize{title}% |
| \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}} |
| \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}} |
| \def\chapfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl |
| \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc |
| \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{chap}% |
| \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}} |
| \def\secfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl |
| \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc |
| \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\secttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{sec}% |
| \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{17pt}} |
| \def\subsecfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl |
| \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc |
| \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{ssec}% |
| \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}} |
| \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts |
| \def\reducedfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl |
| \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc |
| \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{reduced}% |
| \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
| \def\smallfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl |
| \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc |
| \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy |
| \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{small}% |
| \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}} |
| \def\smallerfonts{% |
| \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl |
| \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc |
| \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy |
| \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl |
| \def\curfontsize{smaller}% |
| \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}% |
| \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}} |
| |
| % Fonts for short table of contents. |
| \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12 |
| \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1} |
| \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT} |
| |
| % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts. |
| \def\angleleft{$\langle$} |
| \def\angleright{$\rangle$} |
| |
| % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments. |
| \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts |
| |
| % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample |
| % can fit this many characters: |
| % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69 |
| % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters: |
| % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77 |
| % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth |
| % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt. |
| % |
| % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt): |
| % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58 |
| % --karl, 24jan03. |
| |
| % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes. |
| % |
| \definetextfontsizexi |
| |
| |
| \message{markup,} |
| |
| % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the |
| % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and |
| % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have |
| % this property, we can check that font parameter. |
| % |
| \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt } |
| |
| % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will |
| % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes. |
| % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost |
| % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles |
| % currently in effect. |
| \newif\ifmarkupvar |
| \newif\ifmarkupsamp |
| \newif\ifmarkupkey |
| %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp. |
| %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp. |
| \newif\ifmarkupcode |
| \newif\ifmarkupkbd |
| %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code. |
| %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code. |
| \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now). |
| \newif\ifmarkupexample |
| \newif\ifmarkupverb |
| \newif\ifmarkupverbatim |
| |
| \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty |
| |
| \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{% |
| \csname markup#1true\endcsname |
| \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}% |
| \markupstylesetup |
| } |
| |
| \let\markupstylesetup\empty |
| |
| \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{% |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup |
| \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}% |
| \def#1% |
| } |
| |
| % Markup style setup for left and right quotes. |
| \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{% |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp |
| \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname |
| \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi |
| } |
| |
| \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{% |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp |
| \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname |
| \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi |
| } |
| |
| { |
| \catcode`\'=\active |
| \catcode`\`=\active |
| |
| \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq} |
| \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq} |
| |
| \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft} |
| \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright} |
| } |
| |
| \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright |
| % |
| \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright |
| % |
| \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright |
| % |
| \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright |
| % |
| \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright |
| % |
| \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft |
| \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright |
| |
| % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe |
| % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d). |
| % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it |
| % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the |
| % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27. |
| % |
| \def\codequoteright{% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax |
| '% |
| \else \char'15 \fi |
| \else \char'15 \fi |
| } |
| % |
| % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent. |
| % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like |
| % the code environments to do likewise. |
| % |
| \def\codequoteleft{% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax |
| % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391 |
| % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. |
| \relax`% |
| \else \char'22 \fi |
| \else \char'22 \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Commands to set the quote options. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\onword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname |
| = t% |
| \else\ifx\temp\offword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname |
| = \relax |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| % |
| \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\onword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname |
| = t% |
| \else\ifx\temp\offword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname |
| = \relax |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font. |
| \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq} |
| |
| % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks |
| \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0 |
| |
| % Font commands. |
| |
| % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant. |
| % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl, |
| % and 2) do not add an italic correction. |
| \def\dosmartslant#1#2{% |
| \ifusingtt |
| {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}% |
| {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}% |
| \next |
| } |
| \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl} |
| \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it} |
| |
| % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following |
| % character) is such as not to need one. |
| \def\smartitaliccorrection{% |
| \ifx\next,% |
| \else\ifx\next-% |
| \else\ifx\next.% |
| \else\ifx\next\.% |
| \else\ifx\next\comma% |
| \else\ptexslash |
| \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
| \aftersmartic |
| } |
| |
| % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns. |
| \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}} |
| |
| % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want |
| % ttsl for book titles, do we? |
| \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection} |
| |
| \def\aftersmartic{} |
| \def\var#1{% |
| \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic |
| \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}% |
| \smartslanted{#1}% |
| } |
| |
| \let\i=\smartitalic |
| \let\slanted=\smartslanted |
| \let\dfn=\smartslanted |
| \let\emph=\smartitalic |
| |
| % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii. |
| \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font |
| \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font |
| \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font |
| |
| % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong. |
| \def\b#1{{\bf #1}} |
| \let\strong=\b |
| |
| % @sansserif, explicit sans. |
| \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}} |
| |
| % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at |
| % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the |
| % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called. |
| % |
| \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation} |
| \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- } |
| |
| % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value. |
| % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and |
| % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up. |
| % |
| \catcode`@=11 |
| \def\plainfrenchspacing{% |
| \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m |
| \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m |
| \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends |
| } |
| \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{% |
| \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000 |
| \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250 |
| \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends |
| } |
| \catcode`@=\other |
| \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default |
| |
| % @t, explicit typewriter. |
| \def\t#1{% |
| {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}% |
| \null |
| } |
| |
| % @samp. |
| \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}} |
| |
| % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes. |
| \let\indicateurl=\samp |
| |
| % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same |
| % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc. |
| % This is a subroutine for that. |
| \def\tclose#1{% |
| {% |
| % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font. |
| \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font |
| % |
| % Switch to typewriter. |
| \tt |
| % |
| % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space. |
| \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}% |
| % |
| % Turn off hyphenation. |
| \nohyphenation |
| % |
| \rawbackslash |
| \plainfrenchspacing |
| #1% |
| }% |
| \null % reset spacefactor to 1000 |
| } |
| |
| % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code. |
| % (But see \codedashfinish below.) |
| % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes |
| % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc. |
| % |
| % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control |
| % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words. |
| % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that) |
| % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms. |
| { |
| \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active |
| \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active |
| \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions |
| % |
| \global\def\code{\begingroup |
| \setupmarkupstyle{code}% |
| % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers. |
| \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active |
| \ifallowcodebreaks |
| \let-\codedash |
| \let_\codeunder |
| \else |
| \let-\normaldash |
| \let_\realunder |
| \fi |
| % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break |
| % after the hyphen. |
| \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash |
| % |
| \codex |
| } |
| % |
| \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish} |
| \gdef\codedashfinish{% |
| \normaldash % always output the dash character itself. |
| % |
| % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless |
| % (a) the next character is a -, or |
| % (b) the preceding character is a -. |
| % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -. |
| % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b. |
| \ifx\next\codedash \else |
| \ifx\codedashprev\codedash |
| \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi |
| \fi |
| % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a |
| % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}. |
| \global\let\codedashprev= \next |
| } |
| } |
| \def\normaldash{-} |
| % |
| \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup} |
| |
| \def\codeunder{% |
| % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _ |
| % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.) |
| % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us |
| % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop. |
| \ifusingtt{\ifmmode |
| \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_. |
| \else\normalunderscore \fi |
| \discretionary{}{}{}}% |
| {\_}% |
| } |
| |
| % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g., |
| % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad. |
| % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at - |
| % and _ on and off. |
| % |
| \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue |
| |
| \def\keywordtrue{true} |
| \def\keywordfalse{false} |
| |
| \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{% |
| \def\txiarg{#1}% |
| \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue |
| \allowcodebreakstrue |
| \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse |
| \allowcodebreaksfalse |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary, |
| % so use \code rather than \samp. |
| \let\command=\code |
| \let\env=\code |
| \let\file=\code |
| \let\option=\code |
| |
| % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional |
| % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and |
| % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in |
| % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url. |
| |
| % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second |
| % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target). |
| \newif\ifurefurlonlylink |
| |
| % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected |
| % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which |
| % didn't support automatic breaking.) |
| \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak} |
| \let\uref=\urefbreak |
| % |
| \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish} |
| \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example |
| \unsepspaces |
| \pdfurl{#1}% |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}% |
| \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
| \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that |
| \else |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg |
| \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt |
| \ifpdf |
| \ifurefurlonlylink |
| % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg |
| \unhbox0 |
| \else |
| % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency, |
| % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc. |
| \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \endlink |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only). |
| \def\urefcatcodes{% |
| \catcode\ampChar=\active \catcode\dotChar=\active |
| \catcode\hashChar=\active \catcode\questChar=\active |
| \catcode\slashChar=\active |
| } |
| { |
| \urefcatcodes |
| % |
| \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup |
| \setupmarkupstyle{code}% |
| \urefcatcodes |
| \let&\urefcodeamp |
| \let.\urefcodedot |
| \let#\urefcodehash |
| \let?\urefcodequest |
| \let/\urefcodeslash |
| \codex |
| } |
| % |
| % By default, they are just regular characters. |
| \global\def&{\normalamp} |
| \global\def.{\normaldot} |
| \global\def#{\normalhash} |
| \global\def?{\normalquest} |
| \global\def/{\normalslash} |
| } |
| |
| % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help |
| % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in |
| % cmtt at least, especially for dots. |
| \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em} |
| \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em} |
| \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax} |
| \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax} |
| % |
| \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch} |
| \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch} |
| \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch} |
| \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch} |
| \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish} |
| { |
| \catcode`\/=\active |
| \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{% |
| \urefprestretch \slashChar |
| % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of |
| % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://. |
| \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi |
| } |
| } |
| |
| % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special |
| % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so |
| % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{% |
| \def\txiarg{#1}% |
| \ifx\txiarg\wordnone |
| \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} |
| \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore |
| \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak} |
| \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter |
| \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak} |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| } |
| \def\wordafter{after} |
| \def\wordbefore{before} |
| \def\wordnone{none} |
| |
| \urefbreakstyle after |
| |
| % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it. |
| % |
| \let\url=\uref |
| |
| % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97. |
| % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf. |
| % |
| %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright} |
| \ifpdf |
| \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish} |
| \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup |
| \unsepspaces |
| \pdfurl{mailto:#1}% |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% |
| \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi |
| \endlink |
| \endgroup} |
| \else |
| \let\email=\uref |
| \fi |
| |
| % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always), |
| % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends), |
| % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always). |
| \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{% |
| \def\txiarg{#1}% |
| \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct |
| \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}% |
| \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample |
| \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
| \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode |
| \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}% |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| } |
| \def\worddistinct{distinct} |
| \def\wordexample{example} |
| \def\wordcode{code} |
| |
| % Default is `distinct'. |
| \kbdinputstyle distinct |
| |
| % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command, |
| % then @kbd has no effect. |
| \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}} |
| |
| \def\xkey{\key} |
| \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{% |
| \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}% |
| \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}% |
| \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi |
| \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi |
| } |
| |
| % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size. |
| %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1} |
| %\font\keysy=cmsy9 |
| %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{% |
| % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{% |
| % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt |
| % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}% |
| % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}% |
| % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}} |
| |
| % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already |
| % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But |
| % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt. |
| % |
| \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}% |
| \nohyphenation |
| \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi |
| #1}\null} |
| |
| % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...} |
| \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup} |
| |
| % @clickstyle @arrow (by default) |
| \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}} |
| \def\click{\arrow} |
| |
| % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the |
| % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt. |
| % |
| \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1} |
| |
| % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'', |
| % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for |
| % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96. |
| %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null} |
| |
| % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like. |
| % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for |
| % all-uppercase. |
| % |
| \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish} |
| \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{% |
| {\selectfonts\lsize #1}% |
| \def\temp{#2}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty \else |
| \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% |
| \fi |
| \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 |
| } |
| |
| % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like. |
| % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing. |
| % |
| \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish} |
| \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{% |
| {\plainfrenchspacing #1}% |
| \def\temp{#2}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty \else |
| \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})% |
| \fi |
| \null % reset \spacefactor=1000 |
| } |
| |
| % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example. |
| % |
| \def\asis#1{#1} |
| |
| % @math outputs its argument in math mode. |
| % |
| % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean |
| % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make |
| % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam, |
| % which is what @var uses. |
| { |
| \catcode`\_ = \active |
| \gdef\mathunderscore{% |
| \catcode`\_=\active |
| \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}% |
| } |
| } |
| % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \. |
| % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no |
| % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care. |
| % |
| % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\. |
| \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi} |
| % |
| \def\math{% |
| \tex |
| \mathunderscore |
| \let\\ = \mathbackslash |
| \mathactive |
| % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode |
| \let\"=\ddot |
| \let\'=\acute |
| \let\==\bar |
| \let\^=\hat |
| \let\`=\grave |
| \let\u=\breve |
| \let\v=\check |
| \let\~=\tilde |
| \let\dotaccent=\dot |
| % have to provide another name for sup operator |
| \let\mathopsup=\sup |
| $\finishmath |
| } |
| \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex. |
| |
| % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math. |
| % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument |
| % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section). |
| % |
| { |
| \catcode`^ = \active |
| \catcode`< = \active |
| \catcode`> = \active |
| \catcode`+ = \active |
| \catcode`' = \active |
| \gdef\mathactive{% |
| \let^ = \ptexhat |
| \let< = \ptexless |
| \let> = \ptexgtr |
| \let+ = \ptexplus |
| \let' = \ptexquoteright |
| } |
| } |
| |
| % for @sub and @sup, if in math mode, just do a normal sub/superscript. |
| % If in text, use math to place as sub/superscript, but switch |
| % into text mode, with smaller fonts. This is a different font than the |
| % one used for real math sub/superscripts (8pt vs. 7pt), but let's not |
| % fix it (significant additions to font machinery) until someone notices. |
| % |
| \def\sub{\ifmmode \expandafter\sb \else \expandafter\finishsub\fi} |
| \def\finishsub#1{$\sb{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}% |
| % |
| \def\sup{\ifmmode \expandafter\ptexsp \else \expandafter\finishsup\fi} |
| \def\finishsup#1{$\ptexsp{\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize #1}}$}% |
| |
| % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command, but leave this definition for fun. |
| \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1} |
| |
| % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}. |
| % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex, |
| % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about. |
| % |
| \def\outfmtnametex{tex} |
| % |
| \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish} |
| \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{% |
| \def\inlinefmtname{#1}% |
| \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi |
| } |
| % |
| % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if |
| % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT. |
| \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish} |
| \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{% |
| \def\inlinefmtname{#1}% |
| \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi |
| } |
| % |
| % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid |
| % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for |
| % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being |
| % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal |
| % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as |
| % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the |
| % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill. |
| % |
| \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw} |
| \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish} |
| \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{% |
| \def\inlinerawname{#1}% |
| \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi |
| \endgroup % close group opened by \tex. |
| } |
| |
| % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set. |
| % |
| \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish} |
| \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{% |
| \def\inlinevarname{#1}% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax |
| \else\ignorespaces#2\fi |
| } |
| |
| % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set. |
| % |
| \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish} |
| \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{% |
| \def\inlinevarname{#1}% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi |
| } |
| |
| |
| \message{glyphs,} |
| % and logos. |
| |
| % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}. |
| \def\@{\char64 } |
| \let\atchar=\@ |
| |
| % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters. |
| % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do |
| % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math. |
| \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}} |
| \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}} |
| \let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{ |
| \let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\} |
| \begingroup |
| % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices, |
| % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files. |
| \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other |
| \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2 |
| \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other |
| !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]% |
| !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]% |
| !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]% |
| !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]% |
| !endgroup |
| |
| % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems. |
| \let\comma = , |
| |
| % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent |
| % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H. |
| \let\, = \ptexc |
| \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot |
| \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}} |
| \let\tieaccent = \ptext |
| \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb |
| \let\udotaccent = \d |
| |
| % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm |
| % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss. |
| \def\questiondown{?`} |
| \def\exclamdown{!`} |
| \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}} |
| \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}} |
| |
| % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents. |
| \def\imacro{i} |
| \def\jmacro{j} |
| \def\dotless#1{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi |
| \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi |
| \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a |
| % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.) |
| % |
| \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 } |
| |
| % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in |
| % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most |
| % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using |
| % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and |
| % \scriptscriptstyle). |
| % |
| \def\LaTeX{% |
| L\kern-.36em |
| {\setbox0=\hbox{T}% |
| \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{% |
| \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt |
| % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX. |
| % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt. |
| \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$% |
| \else |
| % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize. |
| \selectfonts\lllsize A% |
| \fi |
| }% |
| \vss |
| }}% |
| \kern-.15em |
| \TeX |
| } |
| |
| % Some math mode symbols. |
| \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$} |
| \def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi} |
| \def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi} |
| \def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi} |
| |
| % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font. |
| % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm |
| % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand, |
| % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do |
| % whichever is larger. |
| % |
| \def\dots{% |
| \leavevmode |
| \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods |
| \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em |
| \dimen0 = \wd0 |
| \else |
| \dimen0 = 1.5em |
| \fi |
| \hbox to \dimen0{% |
| \hskip 0pt plus.25fil |
| .\hskip 0pt plus1fil |
| .\hskip 0pt plus1fil |
| .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis. |
| % |
| \def\enddots{% |
| \dots |
| \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor |
| } |
| |
| % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}. |
| % |
| % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of |
| % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em. |
| % |
| \def\point{$\star$} |
| \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}} |
| \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}} |
| \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}} |
| \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}} |
| \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}} |
| |
| % The @error{} command. |
| % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit. |
| % |
| \newbox\errorbox |
| % |
| {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box. |
| \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules |
| % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.) |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt} |
| % |
| \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil |
| \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right. |
| \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules. |
| \vbox{% |
| \hrule height\dimen2 |
| \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text. |
| \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below. |
| \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right. |
| \hrule height\dimen2} |
| \hfil} |
| % |
| \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox} |
| |
| % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font. |
| % |
| \def\pounds{{\it\$}} |
| |
| % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style. |
| % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik |
| % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and |
| % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need). |
| % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym. |
| % |
| % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore |
| % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular |
| % font height. |
| % |
| % feymr - regular |
| % feymo - slanted |
| % feybr - bold |
| % feybo - bold slanted |
| % |
| % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge. |
| % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide. |
| % Hmm. |
| % |
| % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols? |
| % Hope not. |
| % |
| % |
| \def\euro{{\eurofont e}} |
| \def\eurofont{% |
| % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in |
| % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that |
| % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the |
| % font installed. |
| % |
| % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale |
| % that to the current nominal size. |
| % |
| % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but |
| % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts. |
| % |
| \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% |
| % |
| \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename |
| % bold: |
| \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize |
| \else |
| % regular: |
| \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize |
| \fi |
| \thiseurofont |
| } |
| |
| % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because |
| % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect |
| % the redefinition. |
| % |
| % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters. |
| \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth |
| \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth |
| \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn |
| \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn |
| % |
| \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}} |
| \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft} |
| \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}} |
| \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright} |
| \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}} |
| \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}} |
| \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}} |
| \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}} |
| % |
| % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but |
| % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the |
| % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer |
| % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc. |
| % |
| % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using |
| % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in |
| % the same EC font. |
| \def\ogonek#1{{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek |
| \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek |
| \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek |
| \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek |
| \else |
| \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}% |
| \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1% |
| \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}% |
| \fi |
| \fi\fi\fi\fi |
| }% |
| } |
| \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A} |
| \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a} |
| \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E} |
| \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e} |
| % |
| % Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs. |
| \def\ecfont{% |
| % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this |
| % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German |
| % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so |
| % hopefully nobody will notice/care. |
| \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}% |
| \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}% |
| \ifmonospace |
| % typewriter: |
| \font\thisecfont = ectt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize |
| \else |
| \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename |
| % bold: |
| \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize |
| \else |
| % regular: |
| \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \thisecfont |
| } |
| |
| % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really |
| % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now. |
| % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright. |
| % |
| \def\registeredsymbol{% |
| $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}% |
| \hfil\crcr\Orb}}% |
| }$% |
| } |
| |
| % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign. |
| % |
| \def\textdegree{$^\circ$} |
| |
| % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with: |
| % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38 |
| % so we'll define it if necessary. |
| % |
| \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined |
| \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D} |
| \fi |
| |
| % Quotes. |
| \chardef\quotedblleft="5C |
| \chardef\quotedblright=`\" |
| \chardef\quoteleft=`\` |
| \chardef\quoteright=`\' |
| |
| |
| \message{page headings,} |
| |
| \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in |
| \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc |
| |
| % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage. |
| \newif\ifseenauthor |
| \newif\iffinishedtitlepage |
| |
| % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the |
| % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage. |
| % |
| \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
| \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
| \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
| \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue |
| |
| \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{% |
| \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}% |
| \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page} |
| |
| \envdef\titlepage{% |
| % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage. |
| \begingroup |
| \parindent=0pt \textfonts |
| % Leave some space at the very top of the page. |
| \vglue\titlepagetopglue |
| % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title. |
| \finishedtitlepagetrue |
| % |
| % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space |
| % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second. |
| \let\oldpage = \page |
| \def\page{% |
| \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
| \finishtitlepage |
| \fi |
| \let\page = \oldpage |
| \page |
| \null |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| \def\Etitlepage{% |
| \iffinishedtitlepage\else |
| \finishtitlepage |
| \fi |
| % It is important to do the page break before ending the group, |
| % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group. |
| % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page |
| % after the title page, which we certainly don't want. |
| \oldpage |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are |
| % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers. |
| \HEADINGSon |
| % |
| % If they want short, they certainly want long too. |
| \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage |
| \shortcontents |
| \contents |
| \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
| \global\let\contents = \relax |
| \fi |
| % |
| \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage |
| \contents |
| \global\let\contents = \relax |
| \global\let\shortcontents = \relax |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \def\finishtitlepage{% |
| \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize |
| \vskip\titlepagebottomglue |
| \finishedtitlepagetrue |
| } |
| |
| % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation, |
| % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used |
| % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. Because |
| % it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold. \par |
| % should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group. |
| % |
| \def\raggedtitlesettings{% |
| \rmisbold |
| \hyphenpenalty=10000 |
| \parindent=0pt |
| \tolerance=5000 |
| \ptexraggedright |
| } |
| |
| % Macros to be used within @titlepage: |
| |
| \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm |
| \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines} |
| |
| \parseargdef\title{% |
| \checkenv\titlepage |
| \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% |
| % print a rule at the page bottom also. |
| \finishedtitlepagefalse |
| \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt |
| } |
| |
| \parseargdef\subtitle{% |
| \checkenv\titlepage |
| {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}% |
| } |
| |
| % @author should come last, but may come many times. |
| % It can also be used inside @quotation. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\author{% |
| \def\temp{\quotation}% |
| \ifx\thisenv\temp |
| \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation. |
| \else |
| \checkenv\titlepage |
| \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi |
| {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| |
| % Set up page headings and footings. |
| |
| \let\thispage=\folio |
| |
| \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages |
| \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages |
| \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages |
| \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages |
| |
| % Now make TeX use those variables |
| \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline |
| \else \the\evenheadline \fi}} |
| \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline |
| \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook} |
| \let\HEADINGShook=\relax |
| |
| % Commands to set those variables. |
| % For example, this is what @headings on does |
| % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter |
| % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle |
| % @evenfooting @thisfile|| |
| % @oddfooting ||@thisfile |
| |
| |
| \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx} |
| \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
| \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
| \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
| |
| \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx} |
| \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
| \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
| \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
| |
| \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}% |
| |
| \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx} |
| \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
| \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
| \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}} |
| |
| \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx} |
| \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish} |
| \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{% |
| \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}% |
| % |
| % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume |
| % @evenfooting will not be used by itself. |
| \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt |
| \global\advance\vsize by -12pt |
| } |
| |
| \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}} |
| |
| % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page |
| % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page |
| % |
| % The same set of arguments for: |
| % |
| % @oddheadingmarks |
| % @evenfootingmarks |
| % @oddfootingmarks |
| % @everyheadingmarks |
| % @everyfootingmarks |
| |
| \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}} |
| \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}} |
| \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}} |
| \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}} |
| \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1} |
| \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} } |
| \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1} |
| \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} } |
| % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom. |
| \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {% |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp |
| } |
| |
| \everyheadingmarks bottom |
| \everyfootingmarks bottom |
| |
| % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing. |
| % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing. |
| % @headings off turns them off. |
| % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility. |
| % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
| % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page. |
| % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page. |
| % By default, they are off at the start of a document, |
| % and turned `on' after @end titlepage. |
| |
| \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname} |
| |
| \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination |
| \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}% |
| \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}% |
| } |
| |
| \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting |
| \HEADINGSoff % it's the default |
| |
| % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1. |
| % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner, |
| % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document |
| % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top |
| % edge of all pages. |
| \def\HEADINGSdouble{% |
| \global\pageno=1 |
| \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
| \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
| } |
| \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
| |
| % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page, |
| % page number on top right. |
| \def\HEADINGSsingle{% |
| \global\pageno=1 |
| \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
| } |
| \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble} |
| |
| \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex} |
| \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter |
| \def\HEADINGSdoublex{% |
| \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}} |
| \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
| } |
| |
| \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex} |
| \def\HEADINGSsinglex{% |
| \global\evenfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\oddfootline={\hfil} |
| \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}} |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
| } |
| |
| % Subroutines used in generating headings |
| % This produces Day Month Year style of output. |
| % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set |
| % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this). |
| \ifx\today\thisisundefined |
| \def\today{% |
| \number\day\space |
| \ifcase\month |
| \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr |
| \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug |
| \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec |
| \fi |
| \space\number\year} |
| \fi |
| |
| % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings. |
| % It generates no output of its own. |
| \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle} |
| \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}} |
| |
| |
| \message{tables,} |
| % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x). |
| |
| % default indentation of table text |
| \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in |
| % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text |
| \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in |
| % margin between end of table item and start of table text. |
| \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in |
| |
| % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin |
| \newdimen\itemmax |
| |
| % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with |
| % these defs. |
| % They also define \itemindex |
| % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none). |
| |
| \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip |
| |
| \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi} |
| |
| \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz} |
| \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz} |
| |
| \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup % |
| \advance\hsize by -\rightskip |
| \advance\hsize by -\tableindent |
| \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}% |
| \itemindex{#1}% |
| \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx. |
| % |
| % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line |
| % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that |
| % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next |
| % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the |
| % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space. |
| \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax |
| % |
| % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping, |
| % but leave it ragged-right. |
| \begingroup |
| \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent |
| \advance\hsize by\tableindent |
| \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax |
| \leavevmode\unhbox0\par |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the |
| % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started. |
| \nobreak \vskip-\parskip |
| % |
| % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if |
| % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no |
| % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would |
| % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this |
| % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert |
| % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also. |
| % |
| \penalty 10001 |
| \endgroup |
| \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse |
| \else |
| % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the |
| % following text (if any) will end up on the same line. |
| \noindent |
| % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in |
| % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and |
| % eventually be printed. |
| \nobreak\kern-\tableindent |
| \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 |
| \unhbox0 |
| \nobreak\kern\dimen0 |
| \endgroup |
| \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}} |
| \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}} |
| |
| % @table, @ftable, @vtable. |
| \envdef\table{% |
| \let\itemindex\gobble |
| \tablecheck{table}% |
| } |
| \envdef\ftable{% |
| \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}% |
| \tablecheck{ftable}% |
| } |
| \envdef\vtable{% |
| \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}% |
| \tablecheck{vtable}% |
| } |
| \def\tablecheck#1{% |
| \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active |
| \endgroup |
| \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is |
| that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}% |
| \def\next{\doignore{#1}}% |
| \else |
| \let\next\tablex |
| \fi |
| \next |
| } |
| \def\tablex#1{% |
| \def\itemindicate{#1}% |
| \parsearg\tabley |
| } |
| \def\tabley#1{% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}% |
| \expandafter |
| }\temp \endtablez |
| } |
| \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{% |
| \aboveenvbreak |
| \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi |
| \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi |
| \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi |
| \itemmax=\tableindent |
| \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin |
| \advance \leftskip by \tableindent |
| \exdentamount=\tableindent |
| \parindent = 0pt |
| \parskip = \smallskipamount |
| \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi |
| \let\item = \internalBitem |
| \let\itemx = \internalBitemx |
| } |
| \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak} |
| \let\Eftable\Etable |
| \let\Evtable\Etable |
| \let\Eitemize\Etable |
| \let\Eenumerate\Etable |
| |
| % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize |
| |
| \newcount \itemno |
| |
| \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize} |
| |
| \def\doitemize#1{% |
| \aboveenvbreak |
| \itemmax=\itemindent |
| \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin |
| \advance\leftskip by \itemindent |
| \exdentamount=\itemindent |
| \parindent=0pt |
| \parskip=\smallskipamount |
| \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi |
| % |
| % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says |
| % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error |
| % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the |
| % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if |
| % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w. |
| \def\itemcontents{#1}% |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}% |
| % |
| % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet. |
| \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi |
| % |
| \let\item=\itemizeitem |
| } |
| |
| % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate. |
| % |
| \def\itemizeitem{% |
| \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations |
| {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break |
| {% |
| % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a |
| % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have |
| % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero |
| % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the |
| % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there |
| % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much |
| % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least |
| % that's the theory. |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi |
| \noindent |
| \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}% |
| % |
| \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item. |
| \flushcr |
| } |
| |
| % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in |
| % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder. |
| % |
| \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}% |
| |
| % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter, |
| % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No |
| % argument is the same as `1'. |
| % |
| \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey} |
| \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{% |
| % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'. |
| \def\thearg{#1}% |
| \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi |
| % |
| % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a |
| % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number. |
| % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made. |
| % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at |
| % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.) |
| \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark |
| \ifx\rest\empty |
| % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything. |
| % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero. |
| % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and |
| % not equal to itself. |
| % Otherwise, we assume it's a number. |
| % |
| % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from |
| % continuing to look for a <number>. |
| % |
| \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax |
| \numericenumerate % a number (we hope) |
| \else |
| % It's a letter. |
| \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax |
| \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter |
| \else |
| \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \else |
| % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number. |
| \numericenumerate |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is |
| % given in \thearg. |
| % |
| \def\numericenumerate{% |
| \itemno = \thearg |
| \startenumeration{\the\itemno}% |
| } |
| |
| % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg. |
| \def\lowercaseenumerate{% |
| \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
| \startenumeration{% |
| % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
| \ifnum\itemno=0 |
| \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
| alphabet}% |
| \fi |
| \char\lccode\itemno |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg. |
| \def\uppercaseenumerate{% |
| \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg |
| \startenumeration{% |
| % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet. |
| \ifnum\itemno=0 |
| \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger |
| alphabet} |
| \fi |
| \char\uccode\itemno |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the |
| % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in |
| % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno. |
| % |
| \def\startenumeration#1{% |
| \advance\itemno by -1 |
| \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr |
| } |
| |
| % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg |
| % to @enumerate. |
| % |
| \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}} |
| \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}} |
| \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
| \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate} |
| |
| |
| % @multitable macros |
| % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96 |
| % |
| % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired. |
| % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width |
| % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line, |
| % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page. |
| |
| % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines. |
| |
| % To make preamble: |
| % |
| % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize: |
| % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45 |
| % @item ... |
| % |
| % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total |
| % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many |
| % columns as desired. |
| |
| |
| % Or use a template: |
| % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
| % @item ... |
| % using the widest term desired in each column. |
| |
| % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column |
| % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's |
| % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed, |
| % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns. |
| |
| % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt |
| % if they are. |
| |
| % Sample multitable: |
| |
| % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template} |
| % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col |
| % @item |
| % first col stuff |
| % @tab |
| % second col stuff |
| % @tab |
| % third col |
| % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff |
| % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column. |
| % |
| % They will wrap at the width determined by the template. |
| % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column. |
| % @end multitable |
| |
| % Default dimensions may be reset by user. |
| % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table. |
| % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table. |
| % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns. |
| % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline |
| % to baseline. |
| % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing. |
| % |
| \newskip\multitableparskip |
| \newskip\multitableparindent |
| \newdimen\multitablecolspace |
| \newskip\multitablelinespace |
| \multitableparskip=0pt |
| \multitableparindent=6pt |
| \multitablecolspace=12pt |
| \multitablelinespace=0pt |
| |
| % Macros used to set up halign preamble: |
| % |
| \let\endsetuptable\relax |
| \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable} |
| \let\columnfractions\relax |
| \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions} |
| \newif\ifsetpercent |
| |
| % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might |
| % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is. |
| % |
| \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {% |
| \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}% |
| \setuptable |
| } |
| |
| \newcount\colcount |
| \def\setuptable#1{% |
| \def\firstarg{#1}% |
| \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable |
| \let\go = \relax |
| \else |
| \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions |
| \global\setpercenttrue |
| \else |
| \ifsetpercent |
| \let\go\pickupwholefraction |
| \else |
| \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
| \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a |
| % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway. |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction |
| % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so |
| % we'll always have a period there to be parsed. |
| \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}% |
| \else |
| \let\go = \setuptable |
| \fi% |
| \fi |
| \go |
| } |
| |
| % multitable-only commands. |
| % |
| % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold. Assignments |
| % have to be global since we are inside the implicit group of an |
| % alignment entry. \everycr below resets \everytab so we don't have to |
| % undo it ourselves. |
| \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable |
| \def\headitem{% |
| \checkenv\multitable |
| \crcr |
| \gdef\headitemcrhook{\nobreak}% attempt to avoid page break after headings |
| \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs |
| \the\everytab % for the first item |
| }% |
| % |
| % default for tables with no headings. |
| \let\headitemcrhook=\relax |
| % |
| % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template |
| % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until |
| % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve. |
| % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99. |
| \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}% |
| |
| % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions: |
| % |
| \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab. |
| % |
| \envdef\multitable{% |
| \vskip\parskip |
| \startsavinginserts |
| % |
| % @item within a multitable starts a normal row. |
| % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries |
| % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka |
| % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize. |
| \def\item{\crcr}% |
| % |
| \tolerance=9500 |
| \hbadness=9500 |
| \setmultitablespacing |
| \parskip=\multitableparskip |
| \parindent=\multitableparindent |
| \overfullrule=0pt |
| \global\colcount=0 |
| % |
| \everycr = {% |
| \noalign{% |
| \global\everytab={}% Reset from possible headitem. |
| \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter. |
| % |
| % Check for saved footnotes, etc.: |
| \checkinserts |
| % |
| % Perhaps a \nobreak, then reset: |
| \headitemcrhook |
| \global\let\headitemcrhook=\relax |
| }% |
| }% |
| % |
| \parsearg\domultitable |
| } |
| \def\domultitable#1{% |
| % To parse everything between @multitable and @item: |
| \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable |
| % |
| % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will |
| % be used as many times as user calls for columns. |
| % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and |
| % continue for many paragraphs if desired. |
| \halign\bgroup &% |
| \global\advance\colcount by 1 |
| \multistrut |
| \vtop{% |
| % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width: |
| \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname |
| % |
| % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other |
| % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after |
| % the first one. |
| % |
| % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace |
| % to the width of each template entry. |
| % |
| % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will |
| % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip |
| % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at |
| % left margin and final column will justify at right margin. |
| % |
| % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment. |
| \rightskip=0pt |
| \ifnum\colcount=1 |
| % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text. |
| \advance\hsize by\leftskip |
| \else |
| \ifsetpercent \else |
| % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize |
| % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace. |
| \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace |
| \fi |
| % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace: |
| \leftskip=\multitablecolspace |
| \fi |
| % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious |
| % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the |
| % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself. |
| % For example: |
| % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89 |
| % @item @code{#} |
| % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country. |
| % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively |
| % marking characters. |
| \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut |
| }\cr |
| } |
| \def\Emultitable{% |
| \crcr |
| \egroup % end the \halign |
| \global\setpercentfalse |
| } |
| |
| \def\setmultitablespacing{% |
| \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing |
| % |
| % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in |
| % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on |
| % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off. |
| % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100. |
| \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt |
| \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip |
| \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0 |
| \fi |
| % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of |
| % table. If not, do nothing. |
| % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace. |
| \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace |
| \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
| \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
| % than skip between lines in the table. |
| \fi% |
| \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt |
| \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace |
| \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller |
| % than skip between lines in the table. |
| \fi} |
| |
| |
| \message{conditionals,} |
| |
| % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext, |
| % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't |
| % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we |
| % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't |
| % attempt to close an environment group. |
| % |
| \def\makecond#1{% |
| \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax |
| \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1 |
| } |
| \makecond{iftex} |
| \makecond{ifnotdocbook} |
| \makecond{ifnothtml} |
| \makecond{ifnotinfo} |
| \makecond{ifnotplaintext} |
| \makecond{ifnotxml} |
| |
| % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like. |
| % |
| \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}} |
| \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}} |
| \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}} |
| \def\html{\doignore{html}} |
| \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}} |
| \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}} |
| \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}} |
| \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}} |
| \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}} |
| \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}} |
| \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}} |
| \def\menu{\doignore{menu}} |
| \def\xml{\doignore{xml}} |
| |
| % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals. |
| % |
| % A count to remember the depth of nesting. |
| \newcount\doignorecount |
| |
| \def\doignore#1{\begingroup |
| % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode: |
| \obeylines |
| \catcode`\@ = \other |
| \catcode`\{ = \other |
| \catcode`\} = \other |
| % |
| % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants. |
| \spaceisspace |
| % |
| % Count number of #1's that we've seen. |
| \doignorecount = 0 |
| % |
| % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'. |
| \dodoignore{#1}% |
| } |
| |
| { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source. |
| \obeylines % |
| % |
| \gdef\dodoignore#1{% |
| % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'. |
| % |
| % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'. |
| \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{% |
| \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}% |
| % |
| % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a |
| % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for |
| % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.) |
| \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}% |
| % |
| % And now expand that command. |
| \doignoretext ^^M% |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| \def\doignoreyyy#1{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found. |
| \let\next\doignoretextzzz |
| \else % Found a nested condition, ... |
| \advance\doignorecount by 1 |
| \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another. |
| % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example). |
| \fi |
| \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro. |
| } |
| |
| % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_". |
| % |
| \def\doignoretextzzz#1{% |
| \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end. |
| \let\next\enddoignore |
| \else % Still inside a nested condition. |
| \advance\doignorecount by -1 |
| \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end. |
| \fi |
| \next |
| } |
| |
| % Finish off ignored text. |
| { \obeylines% |
| % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim |
| % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional |
| % would result in a blank line in the output. |
| \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}% |
| } |
| |
| |
| % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value. |
| % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE. |
| % |
| % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be |
| % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our |
| % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we |
| % didn't need it. |
| % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy} |
| \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \def\temp{#2}% |
| \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty |
| \next{}% |
| \else |
| \setzzz#2\endsetzzz |
| \fi |
| }% |
| } |
| % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted. |
| \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}} |
| |
| % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\clear{% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo. |
| \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx} |
| \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup} |
| { |
| \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active |
| % |
| \gdef\makevalueexpandable{% |
| \let\value = \expandablevalue |
| % We don't want these characters active, ... |
| \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other |
| % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if |
| % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though. |
| % So \let them to their normal equivalents. |
| \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore |
| } |
| } |
| |
| % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's |
| % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies). |
| % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since |
| % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the |
| % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain |
| % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work |
| % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete). |
| % |
| % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value* |
| % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr |
| % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's |
| % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it. |
| % |
| \def\expandablevalue#1{% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax |
| {[No value for ``#1'']}% |
| \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}% |
| \else |
| \csname SET#1\endcsname |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined |
| % with @set. |
| % |
| % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call |
| % \makecond and then redefine. |
| % |
| \makecond{ifset} |
| \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}} |
| \def\doifset#1#2{% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \let\next=\empty |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax |
| #1% If not set, redefine \next. |
| \fi |
| \expandafter |
| }\next |
| } |
| \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}} |
| |
| % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been |
| % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear. |
| % |
| % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the |
| % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set, |
| % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail. |
| % |
| \makecond{ifclear} |
| \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}} |
| \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}} |
| |
| % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written |
| % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the |
| % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered |
| % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command. |
| % |
| \makecond{ifcommanddefined} |
| \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}} |
| % |
| \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \let\next=\empty |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax |
| #1% If not defined, \let\next as above. |
| \fi |
| \expandafter |
| }\next |
| } |
| \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}} |
| |
| % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above. |
| \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined} |
| \def\ifcommandnotdefined{% |
| \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}} |
| \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}} |
| |
| % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to |
| % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available. |
| \set txicommandconditionals |
| |
| % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file |
| % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX. |
| \let\dircategory=\comment |
| |
| % @defininfoenclose. |
| \let\definfoenclose=\comment |
| |
| |
| \message{indexing,} |
| % Index generation facilities |
| |
| % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite |
| % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's. |
| \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}} |
| |
| % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo. |
| % It automatically defines \fooindex such that |
| % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo. |
| % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for |
| % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo. |
| % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long |
| % for the sake of vms. |
| % |
| \def\newindex#1{% |
| \iflinks |
| \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
| \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file |
| \fi |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index |
| \noexpand\doindex{#1}} |
| } |
| |
| % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo} |
| % |
| \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex} |
| |
| % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code. |
| % |
| \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex} |
| % |
| \def\newcodeindex#1{% |
| \iflinks |
| \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname |
| \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 |
| \fi |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% |
| \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}% |
| } |
| |
| |
| % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar. |
| % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index. |
| % |
| % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo |
| % inside @code. |
| % |
| \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}} |
| \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}} |
| |
| % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo), |
| % #3 the target index (bar). |
| \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{% |
| % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up |
| % closing the target index. |
| \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax |
| % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the |
| % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files. |
| \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname |
| \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1 |
| \fi |
| % redefine \fooindfile: |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname |
| \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp |
| % redefine \fooindex: |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}% |
| } |
| |
| % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros. |
| % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro, |
| % and it is "foo", the name of the index. |
| |
| % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work. |
| % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros. |
| |
| % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic} |
| % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index. |
| |
| \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer} |
| \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}} |
| |
| % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument. |
| \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer} |
| \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}} |
| |
| % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry. |
| % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't, |
| % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't. |
| % |
| \def\indexdummies{% |
| \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files. |
| \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files. |
| \def\ {\realbackslash\space }% |
| % |
| % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy) |
| % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more |
| % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again. |
| % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes |
| % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we |
| % should use @lbracechar and @rbracechar? |
| \def\{{{\tt\char123}}% |
| \def\}{{\tt\char125}}% |
| % |
| % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is |
| % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts |
| % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is, |
| % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput |
| % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput |
| % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that |
| % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it |
| % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that |
| % is still getting written without apparent harm. |
| % |
| % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to |
| % help-texinfo, 22may06): |
| % @macro funindex {WORD} |
| % @findex xyz |
| % @end macro |
| % ... |
| % @funindex commtest |
| % This is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor. |
| % |
| % Sample whatsit resulting: |
| % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}} |
| % |
| % So: |
| \let\endinput = \empty |
| % |
| % Do the redefinitions. |
| \commondummies |
| } |
| |
| % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to |
| % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of |
| % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @, |
| % this will be simpler. |
| % |
| \def\atdummies{% |
| \def\@{@@}% |
| \def\ {@ }% |
| \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd |
| \let\} = \rbraceatcmd |
| % |
| % Do the redefinitions. |
| \commondummies |
| \otherbackslash |
| } |
| |
| % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies. |
| % |
| \def\commondummies{% |
| % |
| % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively |
| % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words, |
| % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for |
| % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word |
| % from whatever follows. |
| % |
| % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the |
| % space. |
| % |
| % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and |
| % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then |
| % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever). |
| % |
| \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}% |
| \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}% |
| \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter |
| % |
| \commondummiesnofonts |
| % |
| \definedummyletter\_% |
| \definedummyletter\-% |
| % |
| % Non-English letters. |
| \definedummyword\AA |
| \definedummyword\AE |
| \definedummyword\DH |
| \definedummyword\L |
| \definedummyword\O |
| \definedummyword\OE |
| \definedummyword\TH |
| \definedummyword\aa |
| \definedummyword\ae |
| \definedummyword\dh |
| \definedummyword\exclamdown |
| \definedummyword\l |
| \definedummyword\o |
| \definedummyword\oe |
| \definedummyword\ordf |
| \definedummyword\ordm |
| \definedummyword\questiondown |
| \definedummyword\ss |
| \definedummyword\th |
| % |
| % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do. |
| \definedummyword\bf |
| \definedummyword\gtr |
| \definedummyword\hat |
| \definedummyword\less |
| \definedummyword\sf |
| \definedummyword\sl |
| \definedummyword\tclose |
| \definedummyword\tt |
| % |
| \definedummyword\LaTeX |
| \definedummyword\TeX |
| % |
| % Assorted special characters. |
| \definedummyword\arrow |
| \definedummyword\bullet |
| \definedummyword\comma |
| \definedummyword\copyright |
| \definedummyword\registeredsymbol |
| \definedummyword\dots |
| \definedummyword\enddots |
| \definedummyword\entrybreak |
| \definedummyword\equiv |
| \definedummyword\error |
| \definedummyword\euro |
| \definedummyword\expansion |
| \definedummyword\geq |
| \definedummyword\guillemetleft |
| \definedummyword\guillemetright |
| \definedummyword\guilsinglleft |
| \definedummyword\guilsinglright |
| \definedummyword\lbracechar |
| \definedummyword\leq |
| \definedummyword\minus |
| \definedummyword\ogonek |
| \definedummyword\pounds |
| \definedummyword\point |
| \definedummyword\print |
| \definedummyword\quotedblbase |
| \definedummyword\quotedblleft |
| \definedummyword\quotedblright |
| \definedummyword\quoteleft |
| \definedummyword\quoteright |
| \definedummyword\quotesinglbase |
| \definedummyword\rbracechar |
| \definedummyword\result |
| \definedummyword\textdegree |
| % |
| % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write. |
| \macrolist |
| % |
| \normalturnoffactive |
| % |
| % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any |
| % (non-fully-expandable) commands. |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| } |
| |
| % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts. |
| % |
| \def\commondummiesnofonts{% |
| % Control letters and accents. |
| \definedummyletter\!% |
| \definedummyaccent\"% |
| \definedummyaccent\'% |
| \definedummyletter\*% |
| \definedummyaccent\,% |
| \definedummyletter\.% |
| \definedummyletter\/% |
| \definedummyletter\:% |
| \definedummyaccent\=% |
| \definedummyletter\?% |
| \definedummyaccent\^% |
| \definedummyaccent\`% |
| \definedummyaccent\~% |
| \definedummyword\u |
| \definedummyword\v |
| \definedummyword\H |
| \definedummyword\dotaccent |
| \definedummyword\ogonek |
| \definedummyword\ringaccent |
| \definedummyword\tieaccent |
| \definedummyword\ubaraccent |
| \definedummyword\udotaccent |
| \definedummyword\dotless |
| % |
| % Texinfo font commands. |
| \definedummyword\b |
| \definedummyword\i |
| \definedummyword\r |
| \definedummyword\sansserif |
| \definedummyword\sc |
| \definedummyword\slanted |
| \definedummyword\t |
| % |
| % Commands that take arguments. |
| \definedummyword\abbr |
| \definedummyword\acronym |
| \definedummyword\anchor |
| \definedummyword\cite |
| \definedummyword\code |
| \definedummyword\command |
| \definedummyword\dfn |
| \definedummyword\dmn |
| \definedummyword\email |
| \definedummyword\emph |
| \definedummyword\env |
| \definedummyword\file |
| \definedummyword\image |
| \definedummyword\indicateurl |
| \definedummyword\inforef |
| \definedummyword\kbd |
| \definedummyword\key |
| \definedummyword\math |
| \definedummyword\option |
| \definedummyword\pxref |
| \definedummyword\ref |
| \definedummyword\samp |
| \definedummyword\strong |
| \definedummyword\tie |
| \definedummyword\uref |
| \definedummyword\url |
| \definedummyword\var |
| \definedummyword\verb |
| \definedummyword\w |
| \definedummyword\xref |
| % |
| % Consider: |
| % @macro mkind{arg1,arg2} |
| % @cindex \arg2\ |
| % @end macro |
| % @mkind{foo, bar} |
| % The space after the comma will end up in the temporary definition |
| % that we make for arg2 (see \parsemargdef ff.). We want all this to be |
| % expanded for the sake of the index, so we end up just seeing "bar". |
| \let\xeatspaces = \eatspaces |
| } |
| |
| % For testing: output @{ and @} in index sort strings as \{ and \}. |
| \newif\ifusebracesinindexes |
| |
| % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index |
| % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all |
| % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string |
| % would be for a given command (usually its argument). |
| % |
| \def\indexnofonts{% |
| % Accent commands should become @asis. |
| \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}% |
| % We can just ignore other control letters. |
| \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}% |
| % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below. |
| \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent |
| % |
| \commondummiesnofonts |
| % |
| % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command |
| % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc. |
| % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands. |
| %\let\tt=\asis |
| % |
| \def\ { }% |
| \def\@{@}% |
| \def\_{\normalunderscore}% |
| \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting |
| % |
| % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the |
| % content at all. So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings |
| % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }. |
| \ifusebracesinindexes |
| \def\lbracechar{\lbracecmd}% |
| \def\rbracechar{\rbracecmd}% |
| \else |
| \def\lbracechar{|a}% |
| \def\rbracechar{|b}% |
| \fi |
| \let\{=\lbracechar |
| \let\}=\rbracechar |
| % |
| % |
| % Non-English letters. |
| \def\AA{AA}% |
| \def\AE{AE}% |
| \def\DH{DZZ}% |
| \def\L{L}% |
| \def\OE{OE}% |
| \def\O{O}% |
| \def\TH{ZZZ}% |
| \def\aa{aa}% |
| \def\ae{ae}% |
| \def\dh{dzz}% |
| \def\exclamdown{!}% |
| \def\l{l}% |
| \def\oe{oe}% |
| \def\ordf{a}% |
| \def\ordm{o}% |
| \def\o{o}% |
| \def\questiondown{?}% |
| \def\ss{ss}% |
| \def\th{zzz}% |
| % |
| \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}% |
| \def\TeX{TeX}% |
| % |
| % Assorted special characters. |
| % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.) |
| \def\arrow{->}% |
| \def\bullet{bullet}% |
| \def\comma{,}% |
| \def\copyright{copyright}% |
| \def\dots{...}% |
| \def\enddots{...}% |
| \def\equiv{==}% |
| \def\error{error}% |
| \def\euro{euro}% |
| \def\expansion{==>}% |
| \def\geq{>=}% |
| \def\guillemetleft{<<}% |
| \def\guillemetright{>>}% |
| \def\guilsinglleft{<}% |
| \def\guilsinglright{>}% |
| \def\leq{<=}% |
| \def\minus{-}% |
| \def\point{.}% |
| \def\pounds{pounds}% |
| \def\print{-|}% |
| \def\quotedblbase{"}% |
| \def\quotedblleft{"}% |
| \def\quotedblright{"}% |
| \def\quoteleft{`}% |
| \def\quoteright{'}% |
| \def\quotesinglbase{,}% |
| \def\registeredsymbol{R}% |
| \def\result{=>}% |
| \def\textdegree{o}% |
| % |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax |
| \else \indexlquoteignore \fi |
| % |
| % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present). |
| % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now. |
| % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up |
| % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry |
| % that starts with \. |
| % |
| % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them |
| % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that |
| % goes to end-of-line is not handled. |
| % |
| \macrolist |
| } |
| |
| % Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us |
| % ignore left quotes in the sort term. |
| {\catcode`\`=\active |
| \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=\empty}} |
| |
| \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex. |
| \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)? |
| |
| % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case. |
| % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text. |
| \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}} |
| |
| % Workhorse for all \fooindexes. |
| % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry -- |
| % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception |
| % is with most defuns, which call us directly). |
| % |
| \def\dosubind#1#2#3{% |
| \iflinks |
| {% |
| % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg). |
| \toks0 = {#2}% |
| % If third arg is present, precede it with a space. |
| \def\thirdarg{#3}% |
| \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else |
| \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}% |
| % |
| \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite |
| }% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file: |
| % |
| \def\dosubindwrite{% |
| % Put the index entry in the margin if desired. |
| \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else |
| \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Remember, we are within a group. |
| \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage |
| \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now |
| % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash. |
| % |
| % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to |
| % get the string to sort by. |
| {\indexnofonts |
| \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion |
| \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}% |
| }% |
| % |
| % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and |
| % the original text, including any font commands. We write |
| % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the |
| % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s |
| % sorted result. |
| \edef\temp{% |
| \write\writeto{% |
| \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}% |
| }% |
| \temp |
| } |
| |
| % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit: |
| % |
| % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it |
| % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting |
| % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the |
| % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that |
| % sequences like this: |
| % @end defun |
| % @tindex whatever |
| % @defun ... |
| % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the |
| % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of |
| % the previous defun. |
| % |
| % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We |
| % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph. |
| % |
| % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too. |
| % |
| % But wait, there is a catch there: |
| % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not |
| % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts |
| % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual |
| % representation of the skip. |
| % |
| % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that |
| % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter). |
| % |
| \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname} |
| % |
| \newskip\whatsitskip |
| \newcount\whatsitpenalty |
| % |
| % ..., ready, GO: |
| % |
| \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode |
| #1% |
| \else |
| % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously. |
| \whatsitskip = \lastskip |
| \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}% |
| \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty |
| % |
| % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a |
| % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this |
| % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a |
| % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential |
| % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed. |
| \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro |
| \else |
| \vskip-\whatsitskip |
| \fi |
| % |
| #1% |
| % |
| \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro |
| % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and |
| % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want |
| % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various |
| % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any |
| % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example: |
| % @deffn deffn-whatever |
| % @vindex index-whatever |
| % Description. |
| % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit |
| % and the "Description." paragraph. |
| \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi |
| \else |
| % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip, |
| % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item |
| % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak. |
| \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip |
| \fi |
| \fi} |
| |
| % The index entry written in the file actually looks like |
| % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic} |
| % or |
| % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic} |
| % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files |
| % containing these kinds of lines: |
| % \initial {c} |
| % before the first topic whose initial is c |
| % \entry {topic}{pagelist} |
| % for a topic that is used without subtopics |
| % \primary {topic} |
| % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics |
| % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist} |
| % for each subtopic. |
| |
| % Define the user-accessible indexing commands |
| % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex. |
| |
| \def\findex {\fnindex} |
| \def\kindex {\kyindex} |
| \def\cindex {\cpindex} |
| \def\vindex {\vrindex} |
| \def\tindex {\tpindex} |
| \def\pindex {\pgindex} |
| |
| \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub} |
| {\obeylines % |
| \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup % |
| \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}} |
| |
| % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material. |
| |
| % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed. |
| % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered). |
| % |
| \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup |
| \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}% |
| % |
| \smallfonts \rm |
| \tolerance = 9500 |
| \plainfrenchspacing |
| \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression. |
| % |
| % See if the index file exists and is nonempty. |
| % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains |
| % \initial {@} |
| % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces |
| % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence). |
| \catcode`\@ = 11 |
| \openin 1 \jobname.#1s |
| \ifeof 1 |
| % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index, |
| % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the |
| % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure |
| % there is some text. |
| \putwordIndexNonexistent |
| \else |
| % |
| % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof |
| % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so |
| % it can discover if there is anything in it. |
| \read 1 to \temp |
| \ifeof 1 |
| \putwordIndexIsEmpty |
| \else |
| % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape |
| % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change |
| % to make right now. |
| \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}% |
| \catcode`\\ = 0 |
| \escapechar = `\\ |
| \begindoublecolumns |
| \input \jobname.#1s |
| \enddoublecolumns |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself. |
| % Change them to control the appearance of the index. |
| |
| \def\initial#1{{% |
| % Some minor font changes for the special characters. |
| \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt |
| % |
| % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own. |
| \removelastskip |
| % |
| % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus. |
| \nobreak |
| \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip |
| \penalty 0 |
| \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip |
| % |
| % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of |
| % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column |
| % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch |
| % we need before each entry, but it's better. |
| % |
| % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns. |
| \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip |
| \leftline{\secbf #1}% |
| % Do our best not to break after the initial. |
| \nobreak |
| \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip |
| }} |
| |
| % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and |
| % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index |
| % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip. |
| % |
| % A straightforward implementation would start like this: |
| % \def\entry#1#2{... |
| % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to |
| % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge--- |
| % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right. |
| % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text. |
| % --kasal, 21nov03 |
| \def\entry{% |
| \begingroup |
| % |
| % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't |
| % affect previous text. |
| \par |
| % |
| % Do not fill out the last line with white space. |
| \parfillskip = 0in |
| % |
| % No extra space above this paragraph. |
| \parskip = 0in |
| % |
| % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines. |
| \finalhyphendemerits = 0 |
| % |
| % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number |
| % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the |
| % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large |
| % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across |
| % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders. |
| % |
| % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start |
| % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that. |
| \hangindent = 2em |
| % |
| % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line |
| % with blank space. |
| \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil |
| % |
| % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing |
| % columns. |
| \vskip 0pt plus1pt |
| % |
| % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks |
| % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section |
| % titles, for instance. |
| \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% |
| \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}% |
| % |
| % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter): |
| \afterassignment\doentry |
| \let\temp = |
| } |
| \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}% |
| \def\doentry{% |
| \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace. |
| \noindent |
| \aftergroup\finishentry |
| % And now comes the text of the entry. |
| } |
| \def\finishentry#1{% |
| % #1 is the page number. |
| % |
| % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if |
| % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be |
| % cursed by a Unix daemon. |
| \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}% |
| \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt |
| \ % |
| \else |
| % |
| % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out |
| % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the |
| % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.) |
| \hfil\penalty50 |
| \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number. |
| % |
| % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as |
| % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull |
| % \hbox ensues. |
| \ifpdf |
| \pdfgettoks#1.% |
| \ \the\toksA |
| \else |
| \ #1% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \par |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| |
| % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em. |
| \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders |
| \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill} |
| |
| \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}} |
| |
| \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm |
| \def\secondary#1#2{{% |
| \parfillskip=0in |
| \parskip=0in |
| \hangindent=1in |
| \hangafter=1 |
| \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill |
| \ifpdf |
| \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph. |
| \else |
| #2 |
| \fi |
| \par |
| }} |
| |
| % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes. |
| % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say, |
| % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself. |
| \catcode`\@=11 |
| |
| \newbox\partialpage |
| \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize |
| |
| \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns |
| % Grab any single-column material above us. |
| \output = {% |
| % |
| % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a |
| % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output |
| % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is |
| % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In |
| % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal |
| % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this |
| % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case. |
| \ifvoid\partialpage \else |
| \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{% |
| % Unvbox the main output page. |
| \unvbox\PAGE |
| \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip |
| }% |
| }% |
| \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage |
| % |
| % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages. |
| \output = {\doublecolumnout}% |
| % |
| % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this |
| % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11 |
| % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple |
| % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the |
| % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place. |
| % |
| % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between |
| % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it |
| % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant |
| % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt) |
| % as it did when we hard-coded it. |
| % |
| % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we |
| % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially) |
| % been clobbered. |
| % |
| \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize |
| \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize |
| \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2 |
| \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
| % |
| % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here, |
| % since nobody clobbers \vsize.) |
| \vsize = 2\vsize |
| } |
| |
| % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except |
| % the last. |
| % |
| \def\doublecolumnout{% |
| \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth |
| % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal |
| % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the |
| % previous page. |
| \dimen@ = \vsize |
| \divide\dimen@ by 2 |
| \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage |
| % |
| % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right. |
| \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ |
| \onepageout\pagesofar |
| \unvbox255 |
| \penalty\outputpenalty |
| } |
| % |
| % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material, |
| % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2. |
| \def\pagesofar{% |
| \unvbox\partialpage |
| % |
| \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize |
| \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize |
| \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}% |
| } |
| % |
| % All done with double columns. |
| \def\enddoublecolumns{% |
| % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised |
| % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the |
| % following situation: |
| % |
| % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry. |
| % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no |
| % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last |
| % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not |
| % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following |
| % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject |
| % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output |
| % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last |
| % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which |
| % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with |
| % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as |
| % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page |
| % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the |
| % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page |
| % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final |
| % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after |
| % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns |
| % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see |
| % \pagebody), causing an overfull box. |
| % |
| % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the |
| % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281). |
| \penalty0 |
| % |
| \output = {% |
| % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the |
| % current page, no automatic page break. |
| \balancecolumns |
| % |
| % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page, |
| % though, there will be another page break right after this \output |
| % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not |
| % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal |
| % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be |
| % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes |
| % the output somewhat more palatable.) |
| \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}% |
| }% |
| \eject |
| \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns |
| % |
| % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted |
| % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column |
| % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the |
| % \endgroup where \vsize got restored). |
| \pagegoal = \vsize |
| } |
| % |
| % Called at the end of the double column material. |
| \def\balancecolumns{% |
| \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120. |
| \dimen@ = \ht0 |
| \advance\dimen@ by \topskip |
| \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip |
| \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to |
| %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}% |
| \splittopskip = \topskip |
| % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint. |
| {% |
| \vbadness = 10000 |
| \loop |
| \global\setbox3 = \copy0 |
| \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@ |
| \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@ |
| \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt |
| \repeat |
| }% |
| %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}% |
| \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}% |
| \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}% |
| % |
| \pagesofar |
| } |
| \catcode`\@ = \other |
| |
| |
| \message{sectioning,} |
| % Chapters, sections, etc. |
| |
| % Let's start with @part. |
| \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}} |
| \def\partzzz#1{% |
| \chapoddpage |
| \null |
| \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit |
| \begingroup |
| \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text |
| \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with |
| \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc |
| \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page |
| \chapoddpage |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| |
| % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered |
| % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf |
| % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter |
| % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000 |
| % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.) |
| \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000 |
| \newcount\chapno |
| \newcount\secno \secno=0 |
| \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0 |
| \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0 |
| |
| % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ... |
| \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@ |
| % |
| % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno} |
| % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple |
| % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual |
| % letter in the expansion, not just typeset. |
| % |
| \def\appendixletter{% |
| \ifnum\appendixno=`A A% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y% |
| \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z% |
| % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is |
| % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not |
| % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out |
| % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it. |
| \else\char\the\appendixno |
| \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi |
| \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi} |
| |
| % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number |
| % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use |
| % these. @section does likewise. |
| \def\thischapter{} |
| \def\thischapternum{} |
| \def\thischaptername{} |
| \def\thissection{} |
| \def\thissectionnum{} |
| \def\thissectionname{} |
| |
| \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level |
| \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count |
| |
| % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc. |
| \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1} |
| \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name |
| |
| % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc. |
| \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1} |
| \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name |
| |
| % we only have subsub. |
| \chardef\maxseclevel = 3 |
| % |
| % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too. |
| % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in: |
| \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel |
| % |
| % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not: |
| % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored. |
| \def\chapheadtype{N} |
| |
| % Choose a heading macro |
| % #1 is heading type |
| % #2 is heading level |
| % #3 is text for heading |
| \def\genhead#1#2#3{% |
| % Compute the abs. sec. level: |
| \absseclevel=#2 |
| \advance\absseclevel by \secbase |
| % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range: |
| \ifnum \absseclevel < 0 |
| \absseclevel = 0 |
| \else |
| \ifnum \absseclevel > 3 |
| \absseclevel = 3 |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| % The heading type: |
| \def\headtype{#1}% |
| \if \headtype U% |
| \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel |
| \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel |
| \fi |
| \else |
| % Check for appendix sections: |
| \ifnum \absseclevel = 0 |
| \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}% |
| \else |
| \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N% |
| \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}% |
| \fi\fi |
| \fi |
| % Check for numbered within unnumbered: |
| \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel |
| \def\headtype{U}% |
| \else |
| \chardef\unnlevel = 3 |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| % Now print the heading: |
| \if \headtype U% |
| \ifcase\absseclevel |
| \unnumberedzzz{#3}% |
| \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}% |
| \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \if \headtype A% |
| \ifcase\absseclevel |
| \appendixzzz{#3}% |
| \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}% |
| \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \ifcase\absseclevel |
| \chapterzzz{#3}% |
| \or \seczzz{#3}% |
| \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
| } |
| |
| % an interface: |
| \def\numhead{\genhead N} |
| \def\apphead{\genhead A} |
| \def\unnmhead{\genhead U} |
| |
| % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset |
| % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero. |
| % |
| % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers |
| % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty. |
| \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty |
| % |
| \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz |
| \def\chapterzzz#1{% |
| % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such |
| % as an @include file. |
| \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
| \global\advance\chapno by 1 |
| % |
| % Used for \float. |
| \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}% |
| \resetallfloatnos |
| % |
| % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations. |
| \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}% |
| \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}% |
| % |
| % Write the actual heading. |
| \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}% |
| % |
| % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter. |
| \global\let\section = \numberedsec |
| \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
| \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
| } |
| |
| \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz |
| % |
| \def\appendixzzz#1{% |
| \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
| \global\advance\appendixno by 1 |
| \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}% |
| \resetallfloatnos |
| % |
| % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations. |
| \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}% |
| \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}% |
| % |
| \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}% |
| % |
| \global\let\section = \appendixsec |
| \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec |
| \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec |
| } |
| |
| % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}} |
| \def\unnumberedzzz#1{% |
| \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 |
| \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1 |
| % |
| % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures. |
| \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty |
| \resetallfloatnos |
| % |
| % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the |
| % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX |
| % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX |
| % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant |
| % to be executed, not expanded). |
| % |
| % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear |
| % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use |
| % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once, |
| % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for |
| % the toc entries.) |
| \toks0 = {#1}% |
| \message{(\the\toks0)}% |
| % |
| \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}% |
| % |
| \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec |
| \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec |
| \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec |
| } |
| |
| % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered. |
| \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{% |
| % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break |
| % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level. |
| % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04 |
| \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters |
| \unnmhead0{#1}% |
| \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax |
| } |
| |
| % @top is like @unnumbered. |
| \let\top\unnumbered |
| |
| % Sections. |
| % |
| \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz |
| \def\seczzz#1{% |
| \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}% |
| } |
| |
| % normally calls appendixsectionzzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}} |
| \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{% |
| \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}% |
| } |
| \let\appendixsec\appendixsection |
| |
| % normally calls unnumberedseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}} |
| \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{% |
| \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}% |
| } |
| |
| % Subsections. |
| % |
| % normally calls numberedsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}} |
| \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % normally calls appendixsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}} |
| \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}% |
| {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}} |
| \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}% |
| {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % Subsubsections. |
| % |
| % normally numberedsubsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}} |
| \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}% |
| {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % normally appendixsubsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}} |
| \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}% |
| {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz: |
| \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}} |
| \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{% |
| \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1 |
| \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}% |
| {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}% |
| } |
| |
| % These macros control what the section commands do, according |
| % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered). |
| % Define them by default for a numbered chapter. |
| \let\section = \numberedsec |
| \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec |
| \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec |
| |
| % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading |
| |
| \def\majorheading{% |
| {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }% |
| \parsearg\chapheadingzzz |
| } |
| |
| \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz} |
| \def\chapheadingzzz#1{% |
| \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% |
| \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak |
| \suppressfirstparagraphindent |
| } |
| |
| % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading. |
| \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
| \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
| \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
| \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
| \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{} |
| \suppressfirstparagraphindent} |
| |
| % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only |
| % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it), |
| % given all the information in convenient, parsed form. |
| |
| % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative) |
| \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi} |
| |
| % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed) |
| \newskip\chapheadingskip |
| |
| % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it. |
| \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}} |
| \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject} |
| % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will |
| % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't |
| % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page. |
| \def\chapoddpage{% |
| \chappager |
| \ifodd\pageno \else |
| \begingroup |
| \headingsoff |
| \null |
| \chappager |
| \endgroup |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname} |
| |
| \def\CHAPPAGoff{% |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
| \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak |
| \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager} |
| |
| \def\CHAPPAGon{% |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager |
| \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager |
| \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager |
| \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}} |
| |
| \def\CHAPPAGodd{% |
| \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage |
| \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage |
| \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage |
| \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}} |
| |
| \CHAPPAGon |
| |
| % Chapter opening. |
| % |
| % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, |
| % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number. |
| % Not used for @heading series. |
| % |
| % To test against our argument. |
| \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing} |
| \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix} |
| \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc} |
| % |
| \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{% |
| \checkenv{}% chapters, etc., should not start inside an environment. |
| % |
| % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). |
| \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs |
| \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs |
| \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% |
| \gdef\thissection{}}% |
| % |
| \def\temptype{#2}% |
| \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
| \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% |
| \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}% |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
| \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}% |
| \gdef\thischapter{}}% |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
| \toks0={#1}% |
| \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}% |
| % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible |
| % commands in some of the translations. |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{} |
| \noexpand\thischapternum: |
| \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
| }% |
| \else |
| \toks0={#1}% |
| \xdef\lastchapterdefs{% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}% |
| % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible |
| % commands in some of the translations. |
| \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{} |
| \noexpand\thischapternum: |
| \noexpand\thischaptername}% |
| }% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| % |
| % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of |
| % the preceding space. |
| \safewhatsit\domark |
| % |
| % Insert the chapter heading break. |
| \pchapsepmacro |
| % |
| % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points |
| % between here and the heading. |
| \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs |
| \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs |
| \domark |
| % |
| {% |
| \chapfonts \rmisbold |
| \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading % give better error message |
| % |
| % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the |
| % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called |
| % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon. |
| \gdef\lastsection{#1}% |
| % |
| % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix |
| % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''. |
| \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
| \def\toctype{unnchap}% |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry |
| \def\toctype{omit}% |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}% |
| \def\toctype{app}% |
| \else |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}% |
| \def\toctype{numchap}% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| % |
| % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the |
| % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc |
| % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty. |
| \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}% |
| % |
| % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make |
| % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has |
| % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the |
| % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not |
| % being visible, for instance under high magnification. |
| \donoderef{#2}% |
| % |
| % Typeset the actual heading. |
| \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue. |
| \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe |
| \unhbox0 #1\par}% |
| }% |
| \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title |
| \nobreak |
| } |
| |
| % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered. |
| \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax |
| \def\centerparameters{% |
| \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip |
| \leftskip = \rightskip |
| \parfillskip = 0pt |
| } |
| |
| |
| % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not |
| % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03. |
| % |
| \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname} |
| % |
| \def\unnchfopen #1{% |
| \chapoddpage |
| \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}% |
| \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak |
| } |
| \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts |
| \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}% |
| \par\penalty 5000 % |
| } |
| \def\centerchfopen #1{% |
| \chapoddpage |
| \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}% |
| \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak |
| } |
| \def\CHAPFopen{% |
| \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen |
| \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen} |
| |
| |
| % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and |
| % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing. |
| % |
| \newskip\secheadingskip |
| \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}} |
| |
| % Subsection titles. |
| \newskip\subsecheadingskip |
| \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}} |
| |
| % Subsubsection titles. |
| \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip} |
| \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak} |
| |
| |
| % Print any size, any type, section title. |
| % |
| % #1 is the text of the title, |
| % #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), |
| % #3 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), |
| % #4 is the section number. |
| % |
| \def\seckeyword{sec} |
| % |
| \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{% |
| {% |
| \def\sectionlevel{#2}% |
| \def\temptype{#3}% |
| % |
| % It is ok for the @heading series commands to appear inside an |
| % environment (it's been historically allowed, though the logic is |
| % dubious), but not the others. |
| \ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword\else |
| \checkenv{}% non-@*heading should not be in an environment. |
| \fi |
| \let\footnote=\errfootnoteheading |
| % |
| % Switch to the right set of fonts. |
| \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold |
| % |
| % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark). |
| \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs |
| \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
| \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword |
| \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}% |
| \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}% |
| \fi |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
| % Don't redefine \thissection. |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
| \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword |
| \toks0={#1}% |
| \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% |
| % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible |
| % commands in some of the translations. |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} |
| \noexpand\thissectionnum: |
| \noexpand\thissectionname}% |
| }% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword |
| \toks0={#1}% |
| \xdef\lastsectiondefs{% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}% |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}% |
| % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible |
| % commands in some of the translations. |
| \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{} |
| \noexpand\thissectionnum: |
| \noexpand\thissectionname}% |
| }% |
| \fi |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| % |
| % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we |
| % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph |
| % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line. |
| \par |
| % |
| % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of |
| % the preceding space. |
| \safewhatsit\domark |
| % |
| % Insert space above the heading. |
| \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname |
| % |
| % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points |
| % between here and the heading. |
| \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs |
| \domark |
| % |
| % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number. |
| \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
| \def\toctype{unn}% |
| \gdef\lastsection{#1}% |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword |
| % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc, |
| % and don't redefine \lastsection. |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{}% |
| \def\toctype{omit}% |
| \let\sectionlevel=\empty |
| \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% |
| \def\toctype{app}% |
| \gdef\lastsection{#1}% |
| \else |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}% |
| \def\toctype{num}% |
| \gdef\lastsection{#1}% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| % |
| % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro. |
| \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}% |
| % |
| % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex). |
| % Again, see comments in \chapmacro. |
| \donoderef{#3}% |
| % |
| % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed. |
| % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be |
| % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the |
| % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that |
| % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the |
| % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000. |
| \nobreak |
| % |
| % Output the actual section heading. |
| \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright |
| \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number |
| \unhbox0 #1}% |
| }% |
| % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it. |
| % Don't allow stretch, though. |
| \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname |
| % |
| % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it |
| % was followed by glue. |
| \nobreak |
| % |
| % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that |
| % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a |
| % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next |
| % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out |
| % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically |
| % obscuring the section heading with something else. |
| \vskip-\parskip |
| % |
| % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known |
| % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation |
| % and do the needful. |
| \penalty 10001 |
| } |
| |
| |
| \message{toc,} |
| % Table of contents. |
| \newwrite\tocfile |
| |
| % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary. |
| % Called from @chapter, etc. |
| % |
| % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno} |
| % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional |
| % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually |
| % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the |
| % destination to jump to. |
| % |
| % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or |
| % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document. |
| % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the |
| % table of contents chapter openings themselves. |
| % |
| \newif\iftocfileopened |
| \def\omitkeyword{omit}% |
| % |
| \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{% |
| \edef\writetoctype{#1}% |
| \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else |
| \iftocfileopened\else |
| \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc |
| \global\tocfileopenedtrue |
| \fi |
| % |
| \iflinks |
| {\atdummies |
| \edef\temp{% |
| \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}% |
| \temp |
| }% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're |
| % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't |
| % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered |
| % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first |
| % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named |
| % `1', and two named `2'. |
| \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi |
| } |
| |
| |
| % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman |
| % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant |
| % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file. |
| % |
| \def\activecatcodes{% |
| \catcode`\"=\active |
| \catcode`\$=\active |
| \catcode`\<=\active |
| \catcode`\>=\active |
| \catcode`\\=\active |
| \catcode`\^=\active |
| \catcode`\_=\active |
| \catcode`\|=\active |
| \catcode`\~=\active |
| } |
| |
| |
| % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input. |
| \def\readtocfile{% |
| \setupdatafile |
| \activecatcodes |
| \input \tocreadfilename |
| } |
| |
| \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in |
| \newcount\savepageno |
| \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1 |
| |
| % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile. |
| % |
| \def\startcontents#1{% |
| % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should |
| % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain |
| % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro. |
| % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se> |
| \contentsalignmacro |
| \immediate\closeout\tocfile |
| % |
| % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline. |
| % It is abundantly clear what they are. |
| \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}% |
| % |
| \savepageno = \pageno |
| \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly. |
| \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom. |
| \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length. |
| % |
| % Roman numerals for page numbers. |
| \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi |
| } |
| |
| % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on |
| % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined. |
| % |
| \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc} |
| |
| % Normal (long) toc. |
| % |
| \def\contents{% |
| \startcontents{\putwordTOC}% |
| \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space |
| \ifeof 1 \else |
| \readtocfile |
| \fi |
| \vfill \eject |
| \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
| \ifeof 1 \else |
| \pdfmakeoutlines |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| \endgroup |
| \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
| \global\pageno = \savepageno |
| } |
| |
| % And just the chapters. |
| \def\summarycontents{% |
| \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}% |
| % |
| \let\partentry = \shortpartentry |
| \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry |
| \let\appentry = \shortchapentry |
| \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry |
| % We want a true roman here for the page numbers. |
| \secfonts |
| \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf |
| \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt |
| \rm |
| \hyphenpenalty = 10000 |
| \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little. |
| \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{} |
| \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry |
| \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space |
| \ifeof 1 \else |
| \readtocfile |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| \vfill \eject |
| \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect |
| \endgroup |
| \lastnegativepageno = \pageno |
| \global\pageno = \savepageno |
| } |
| \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents |
| |
| % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents. |
| % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter. |
| % |
| \def\shortchaplabel#1{% |
| % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the |
| % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts. |
| % But use \hss just in case. |
| % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after |
| % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.) |
| % |
| % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange |
| % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and |
| % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10 |
| % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters |
| % there are before deciding ... |
| \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}% |
| } |
| |
| % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents. |
| % The first argument is the chapter or section name. |
| % The last argument is the page number. |
| % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ... |
| |
| % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't |
| % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width. |
| % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed. |
| \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}} |
| \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}} |
| % |
| % Parts, in the short toc. |
| \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{% |
| \penalty-300 |
| \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip |
| \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}% |
| } |
| |
| % Chapters, in the main contents. |
| \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
| % |
| % Chapters, in the short toc. |
| % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings. |
| \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{% |
| \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}% |
| } |
| |
| % Appendices, in the main contents. |
| % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box. |
| % |
| \def\appendixbox#1{% |
| % We use M since it's probably the widest letter. |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}% |
| \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}} |
| % |
| \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
| |
| % Unnumbered chapters. |
| \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}} |
| \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}} |
| |
| % Sections. |
| \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
| \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry |
| \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}} |
| |
| % Subsections. |
| \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
| \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry |
| \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}} |
| |
| % And subsubsections. |
| \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}} |
| \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry |
| \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}} |
| |
| % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels. |
| % Same as \defaultparindent. |
| \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt |
| |
| % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the |
| % page number. |
| % |
| % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters |
| % if at all possible; hence the \penalty. |
| \def\dochapentry#1#2{% |
| \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip |
| \begingroup |
| \chapentryfonts |
| \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
| \endgroup |
| \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip |
| } |
| |
| \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
| \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent |
| \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
| \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent |
| \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup |
| \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent |
| \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}% |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries. |
| \let\tocentry = \entry |
| |
| % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title. |
| \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax} |
| |
| \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
| \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}} |
| |
| \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm} |
| \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts} |
| \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts} |
| \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts} |
| |
| |
| \message{environments,} |
| % @foo ... @end foo. |
| |
| % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily. |
| % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works. |
| % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character. |
| |
| \envdef\tex{% |
| \setupmarkupstyle{tex}% |
| \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2 |
| \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6 |
| \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie |
| \catcode `\%=14 |
| \catcode `\+=\other |
| \catcode `\"=\other |
| \catcode `\|=\other |
| \catcode `\<=\other |
| \catcode `\>=\other |
| \catcode `\`=\other |
| \catcode `\'=\other |
| \escapechar=`\\ |
| % |
| % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our |
| % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions. |
| \mathactive |
| % |
| % Inverse of the list at the beginning of the file. |
| \let\b=\ptexb |
| \let\bullet=\ptexbullet |
| \let\c=\ptexc |
| \let\,=\ptexcomma |
| \let\.=\ptexdot |
| \let\dots=\ptexdots |
| \let\equiv=\ptexequiv |
| \let\!=\ptexexclam |
| \let\i=\ptexi |
| \let\indent=\ptexindent |
| \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent |
| \let\{=\ptexlbrace |
| \let\+=\tabalign |
| \let\}=\ptexrbrace |
| \let\/=\ptexslash |
| \let\sp=\ptexsp |
| \let\*=\ptexstar |
| %\let\sup=\ptexsup % do not redefine, we want @sup to work in math mode |
| \let\t=\ptext |
| \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer |
| \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing |
| % |
| \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}% |
| \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}% |
| \def\@{@}% |
| } |
| % There is no need to define \Etex. |
| |
| % Define @lisp ... @end lisp. |
| % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things, |
| % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous). |
| |
| % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp. |
| \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in |
| |
| % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other |
| % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't |
| % have any width. |
| \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf} |
| |
| % This space is always present above and below environments. |
| \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt |
| |
| % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here |
| % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip |
| % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the |
| % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip. |
| % |
| \def\aboveenvbreak{{% |
| % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and |
| % \sectionheading, q.v. |
| \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else |
| \advance\envskipamount by \parskip |
| \endgraf |
| \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount |
| \removelastskip |
| % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak |
| % or better ... |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi |
| \vskip\envskipamount |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| }} |
| |
| \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak |
| |
| % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will |
| % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again. |
| \let\nonarrowing=\relax |
| |
| % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around |
| % environment contents. |
| \font\circle=lcircle10 |
| \newdimen\circthick |
| \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner |
| \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip |
| \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle |
| % |
| \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth |
| \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}} |
| \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}} |
| \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}} |
| \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
| \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr |
| \hskip\rskip}} |
| \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip |
| \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr |
| \hskip\rskip}} |
| % |
| \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip |
| |
| \envdef\cartouche{% |
| \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph. |
| \startsavinginserts |
| \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip |
| \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*. |
| \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip |
| \advance\cartinner by-\rskip |
| \cartouter=\hsize |
| \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either |
| % side, and for 6pt waste from |
| % each corner char, and rule thickness |
| \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip |
| % |
| % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the |
| % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can |
| % collide with the section heading. |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi |
| % |
| \vbox\bgroup |
| \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt |
| \carttop |
| \hbox\bgroup |
| \hskip\lskip |
| \vrule\kern3pt |
| \vbox\bgroup |
| \kern3pt |
| \hsize=\cartinner |
| \baselineskip=\normbskip |
| \lineskip=\normlskip |
| \parskip=\normpskip |
| \vskip -\parskip |
| \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group. |
| } |
| \def\Ecartouche{% |
| \ifhmode\par\fi |
| \kern3pt |
| \egroup |
| \kern3pt\vrule |
| \hskip\rskip |
| \egroup |
| \cartbot |
| \egroup |
| \checkinserts |
| } |
| |
| |
| % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants, |
| % inside a group. |
| \newdimen\nonfillparindent |
| \def\nonfillstart{% |
| \aboveenvbreak |
| \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy |
| \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens. |
| \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines |
| \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output |
| \parskip = 0pt |
| % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate |
| % the normal \indent. |
| \nonfillparindent=\parindent |
| \parindent = 0pt |
| \let\indent\nonfillindent |
| % |
| \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes |
| \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
| \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
| \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing |
| \else |
| \let\nonarrowing = \relax |
| \fi |
| \let\exdent=\nofillexdent |
| } |
| |
| \begingroup |
| \obeyspaces |
| % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake |
| % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally |
| % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after |
| % @indent. |
| \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}% |
| \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{% |
| \ifx\temp % |
| \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble% |
| \else% |
| \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox% |
| \fi% |
| }% |
| \endgroup |
| \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent} |
| \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}} |
| |
| % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small. |
| % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall. |
| % This affects the following displayed environments: |
| % @example, @display, @format, @lisp |
| % |
| \def\smallword{small} |
| \def\nosmallword{nosmall} |
| \let\SETdispenvsize\relax |
| \def\setnormaldispenv{% |
| \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword |
| % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank |
| % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but |
| % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient |
| % to change the fonts afterward. |
| \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi |
| \smallexamplefonts \rm |
| \fi |
| } |
| \def\setsmalldispenv{% |
| \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword |
| \else |
| \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi |
| \smallexamplefonts \rm |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo. |
| % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition. |
| \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{% |
| \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}% |
| \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}% |
| \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak |
| \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak |
| } |
| |
| % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment. |
| \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{% |
| \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}% |
| \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}% |
| } |
| % |
| % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font; |
| % @example: same as @lisp. |
| % |
| % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts. |
| % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox. |
| % |
| \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}% |
| \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special. |
| \gobble % eat return |
| } |
| % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font. |
| % |
| \makedispenvdef{display}{% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \gobble |
| } |
| |
| % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins. |
| % |
| \makedispenvdef{format}{% |
| \let\nonarrowing = t% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \gobble |
| } |
| |
| % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize. |
| \envdef\flushleft{% |
| \let\nonarrowing = t% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \gobble |
| } |
| \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak |
| |
| % @flushright. |
| % |
| \envdef\flushright{% |
| \let\nonarrowing = t% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax |
| \gobble |
| } |
| \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak |
| |
| |
| % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right |
| % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special |
| % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right |
| % should be enough. |
| \envdef\raggedright{% |
| \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax |
| \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}% |
| \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}% |
| } |
| \let\Eraggedright\par |
| |
| \envdef\raggedleft{% |
| \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em |
| \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt |
| \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off |
| % badness reporting. |
| } |
| \let\Eraggedleft\par |
| |
| \envdef\raggedcenter{% |
| \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em |
| \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt |
| \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off |
| % badness reporting. |
| } |
| \let\Eraggedcenter\par |
| |
| |
| % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart) |
| % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since |
| % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and |
| % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0. |
| % |
| \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart} |
| % |
| \def\quotationstart{% |
| \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too. |
| \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
| \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing |
| \fi |
| \parsearg\quotationlabel |
| } |
| |
| % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're |
| % doing normal filling. |
| % |
| \def\Equotation{% |
| \par |
| \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else |
| % indent a bit. |
| \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}% |
| \fi |
| {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% |
| } |
| \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation} |
| |
| % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after. |
| \def\quotationlabel#1{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\empty \else |
| {\bf #1: }% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and |
| % has no optional argument. |
| % |
| \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart} |
| % |
| \def\indentedblockstart{% |
| {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip |
| \parindent=0pt |
| % |
| % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down. |
| \ifx\nonarrowing\relax |
| \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing |
| \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing |
| \else |
| \let\nonarrowing = \relax |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling. |
| % |
| \def\Eindentedblock{% |
| \par |
| {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}% |
| } |
| \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock} |
| |
| |
| % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>} |
| % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter, |
| % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg: |
| % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org |
| % |
| % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook. |
| % |
| % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets |
| % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a |
| % verbatim line. |
| \def\dospecials{% |
| \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&% |
| \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~% |
| \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"% |
| % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and |
| % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and |
| % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled. |
| %\do\`\do\'% |
| } |
| % |
| % [Knuth] p. 380 |
| \def\uncatcodespecials{% |
| \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials} |
| % |
| % Setup for the @verb command. |
| % |
| % Eight spaces for a tab |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^I=\active |
| \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }} |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| \def\setupverb{% |
| \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
| \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}% |
| \setupmarkupstyle{verb}% |
| \tabeightspaces |
| % Respect line breaks, |
| % print special symbols as themselves, and |
| % make each space count |
| % must do in this order: |
| \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
| } |
| |
| % Setup for the @verbatim environment |
| % |
| % Real tab expansion. |
| \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount |
| % |
| % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle |
| % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent, |
| % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the |
| % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before |
| % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands |
| % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself. |
| \newbox\verbbox |
| \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup} |
| % |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^I=\active |
| \gdef\tabexpand{% |
| \catcode`\^^I=\active |
| \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup |
| \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab |
| \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw |
| \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw |
| \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw |
| \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox |
| }% |
| } |
| \endgroup |
| |
| % start the verbatim environment. |
| \def\setupverbatim{% |
| \let\nonarrowing = t% |
| \nonfillstart |
| \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim |
| % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would |
| % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode. |
| \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}% |
| \tabexpand |
| \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}% |
| % Respect line breaks, |
| % print special symbols as themselves, and |
| % make each space count. |
| % Must do in this order: |
| \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces |
| \everypar{\starttabbox}% |
| } |
| |
| % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique |
| % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a |
| % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace: |
| % |
| % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1} |
| % |
| % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {} |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other |
| \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next] |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb} |
| % |
| % |
| % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that |
| % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie: |
| % |
| % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1} |
| % |
| % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX, |
| % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}': |
| % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'. |
| % |
| % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx] |
| % |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\ =\active |
| \obeylines % |
| % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end |
| % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank |
| % line in the output. |
| \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}% |
| % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but |
| % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble. |
| \endgroup |
| % |
| \envdef\verbatim{% |
| \setupverbatim\doverbatim |
| } |
| \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak |
| |
| |
| % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment. |
| % |
| \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude} |
| % |
| \def\doverbatiminclude#1{% |
| {% |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| \setupverbatim |
| \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names. |
| \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}% |
| \input #1 |
| \afterenvbreak |
| }% |
| } |
| |
| % @copying ... @end copying. |
| % Save the text away for @insertcopying later. |
| % |
| % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box. |
| % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the |
| % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done |
| % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source |
| % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as |
| % possible is very desirable. |
| % |
| \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying} |
| \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}} |
| % |
| \def\insertcopying{% |
| \begingroup |
| \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page |
| \scanexp\copyingtext |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| |
| |
| \message{defuns,} |
| % @defun etc. |
| |
| \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in |
| \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt |
| \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt |
| \newcount\defunpenalty |
| |
| % Start the processing of @deffn: |
| \def\startdefun{% |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 |
| \medbreak |
| \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the |
| % following @def command, see below. |
| \else |
| % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak, |
| % which is there to keep the function description together with its |
| % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a |
| % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted |
| % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning |
| % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow |
| % a break between a section heading and a defun. |
| % |
| % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling |
| % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the |
| % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following |
| % @def command. |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi |
| % |
| % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break. |
| % But do insert the glue. |
| \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint |
| \fi |
| % |
| \parindent=0in |
| \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent |
| \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
| } |
| |
| \def\dodefunx#1{% |
| % First, check whether we are in the right environment: |
| \checkenv#1% |
| % |
| % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row. |
| % It's not a great place, though. |
| \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi |
| % |
| % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun: |
| \expandafter\gobbledefun#1% |
| } |
| \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{} |
| |
| % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text} |
| % |
| \def\printdefunline#1#2{% |
| \begingroup |
| % call \deffnheader: |
| #1#2 \endheader |
| % common ending: |
| \interlinepenalty = 10000 |
| \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax |
| \endgraf |
| \nobreak\vskip -\parskip |
| \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx |
| % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses, |
| % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize. |
| \checkparencounts |
| \endgroup |
| } |
| |
| \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak} |
| |
| % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn; |
| % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader. |
| % |
| \def\makedefun#1{% |
| \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun |
| \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun |
| \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}% |
| \temp |
| } |
| |
| % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader |
| % |
| % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters. |
| % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly. |
| % |
| \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{% |
| \envdef#1{% |
| \startdefun |
| \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else |
| \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}% |
| }% |
| \def#2{\dodefunx#1}% |
| \def#3% |
| } |
| |
| \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function? |
| \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line? |
| |
| % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions |
| % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun, |
| % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\onword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname |
| = \empty |
| \else\ifx\temp\offword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname |
| = \relax |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp', |
| must be on|off}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % Untyped functions: |
| |
| % @deffn category name args |
| \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}} |
| |
| % @deffn category class name args |
| \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}} |
| |
| % \defopon {category on}class name args |
| \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
| |
| % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args |
| % |
| \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{% |
| % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}. |
| \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}% |
| \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}% |
| } |
| |
| % Typed functions: |
| |
| % @deftypefn category type name args |
| \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}} |
| |
| % @deftypeop category class type name args |
| \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}} |
| |
| % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args |
| \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
| |
| % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args |
| % |
| \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% |
| \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}% |
| \doingtypefntrue |
| \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% |
| } |
| |
| % Typed variables: |
| |
| % @deftypevr category type var args |
| \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}} |
| |
| % @deftypecv category class type var args |
| \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}} |
| |
| % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args |
| \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} } |
| |
| % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args |
| % |
| \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{% |
| \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}% |
| \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}% |
| } |
| |
| % Untyped variables: |
| |
| % @defvr category var args |
| \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} } |
| |
| % @defcv category class var args |
| \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}} |
| |
| % \defcvof {category of}class var args |
| \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} } |
| |
| % Types: |
| |
| % @deftp category name args |
| \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{% |
| \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}% |
| \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}% |
| } |
| |
| % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts: |
| \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } |
| \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} } |
| \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} } |
| \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} } |
| \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} } |
| \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} } |
| \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} } |
| \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon} |
| \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon} |
| \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} |
| \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof} |
| |
| % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args). |
| % #1 is the category, such as "Function". |
| % #2 is the return type, if any. |
| % #3 is the function name. |
| % |
| % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any. |
| % |
| \def\defname#1#2#3{% |
| \par |
| % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def... |
| \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent |
| % |
| % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function |
| % on a line by itself. |
| \rettypeownlinefalse |
| \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically? |
| % then check user option for putting return type on its own line: |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else |
| \rettypeownlinetrue |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| % |
| % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps |
| % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line |
| % just below it. |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi} |
| % |
| % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at |
| % least two. |
| \tempnum = 2 |
| % |
| % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero, |
| % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it: |
| \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip |
| % |
| % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line. |
| \ifrettypeownline |
| \advance\tempnum by 1 |
| \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}% |
| \else |
| \def\maybeshapeline{}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % The continuations: |
| \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent |
| % |
| % The final paragraph shape: |
| \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2 |
| % |
| % Put the category name at the right margin. |
| \noindent |
| \hbox to 0pt{% |
| \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize |
| % \hsize has to be shortened this way: |
| \kern\leftskip |
| % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space. |
| }% |
| % |
| % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint: |
| \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000 |
| \exdentamount=\defbodyindent |
| {% |
| % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because: |
| % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle. |
| % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's |
| % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in |
| % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm. |
| % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures. |
| % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no |
| % one has made identifiers using them :). |
| \df \tt |
| \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type |
| \ifx\temp\empty\else |
| \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type |
| \ifrettypeownline |
| % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following: |
| \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break |
| \else |
| \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space |
| \fi |
| \fi % no return type |
| #3% output function name |
| }% |
| {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm |
| % |
| \boldbrax |
| % arguments will be output next, if any. |
| } |
| |
| % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using |
| % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in |
| % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very |
| % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars. |
| % |
| \def\defunargs#1{% |
| % use sl by default (not ttsl), |
| % tt for the names. |
| \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0 |
| % |
| % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we |
| % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so |
| % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter. |
| % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen |
| % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`. |
| \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}% |
| #1% |
| \sl\hyphenchar\font=45 |
| } |
| |
| % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line. |
| % |
| \def\activeparens{% |
| \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active |
| \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active |
| \catcode`\&=\active |
| } |
| |
| % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars. |
| \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = ) |
| |
| % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example, |
| % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet, |
| % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence. |
| { |
| \activeparens |
| \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen |
| \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack |
| \global\let& = \& |
| |
| \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb} |
| \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm} |
| } |
| |
| \newcount\parencount |
| |
| % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards |
| \newif\ifampseen |
| \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\ }} |
| |
| \def\parenfont{% |
| \ifampseen |
| % At the first level, print parens in roman, |
| % otherwise use the default font. |
| \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi |
| \else |
| % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than |
| % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] . |
| \sf |
| \fi |
| } |
| \def\infirstlevel#1{% |
| \ifampseen |
| \ifnum\parencount=1 |
| #1% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| } |
| \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf} |
| |
| \def\opnr{% |
| \global\advance\parencount by 1 |
| {\parenfont(}% |
| \infirstlevel \bfafterword |
| } |
| \def\clnr{% |
| {\parenfont)}% |
| \infirstlevel \sl |
| \global\advance\parencount by -1 |
| } |
| |
| \newcount\brackcount |
| \def\lbrb{% |
| \global\advance\brackcount by 1 |
| {\bf[}% |
| } |
| \def\rbrb{% |
| {\bf]}% |
| \global\advance\brackcount by -1 |
| } |
| |
| \def\checkparencounts{% |
| \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi |
| \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi |
| } |
| % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually |
| % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers). |
| \def\badparencount{% |
| \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}% |
| \global\parencount=0 |
| } |
| \def\badbrackcount{% |
| \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}% |
| \global\brackcount=0 |
| } |
| |
| |
| \message{macros,} |
| % @macro. |
| |
| % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens, |
| % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX. |
| \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined |
| \newwrite\macscribble |
| \def\scantokens#1{% |
| \toks0={#1}% |
| \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp |
| \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}% |
| \immediate\closeout\macscribble |
| \input \jobname.tmp |
| } |
| \fi |
| |
| \def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup |
| \newlinechar`\^^M |
| \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces |
| % |
| % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex |
| % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active |
| % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had |
| % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears |
| % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04 |
| \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@ |
| % |
| % ... and for \example: |
| \spaceisspace |
| % |
| % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as |
| % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence. It does not |
| % eat a catcode 13 newline. There's no good way to handle the two |
| % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX |
| % would then have different behavior). See the Macro Details node in |
| % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and |
| % line-oriented commands. |
| % |
| \scantokens{#1\empty}% |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| \def\scanexp#1{% |
| \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}% |
| \temp |
| } |
| |
| \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters |
| \newtoks\macname % Macro name |
| \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive? |
| |
| % List of all defined macros in the form |
| % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2... |
| % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split |
| % if there is a need. |
| \def\macrolist{} |
| |
| % Add the macro to \macrolist |
| \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname} |
| \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{% |
| \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}% |
| \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}% |
| } |
| |
| % Utility routines. |
| % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is, |
| % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname |
| % (except of course we have to play expansion games). |
| % |
| \def\cslet#1#2{% |
| \expandafter\let |
| \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname |
| \csname#2\endcsname |
| } |
| |
| % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string. |
| % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN). |
| {\catcode`\@=11 |
| \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }} |
| \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@} |
| \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @} |
| \def\unbrace#1{#1} |
| \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1} |
| } |
| |
| % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string. |
| {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3% |
| \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}% |
| \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}% |
| \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}% |
| } |
| |
| % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where |
| % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active |
| % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \ |
| % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash. |
| % |
| % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate |
| % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to |
| % confine the change to the current group. |
| % |
| % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is |
| % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro |
| % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro. |
| % |
| \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine |
| \catcode`\"=\other |
| \catcode`\+=\other |
| \catcode`\<=\other |
| \catcode`\>=\other |
| \catcode`\@=\other |
| \catcode`\^=\other |
| \catcode`\_=\other |
| \catcode`\|=\other |
| \catcode`\~=\other |
| \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi |
| } |
| |
| \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros. |
| \scanctxt |
| \catcode`\\=\other |
| \catcode`\^^M=\other |
| } |
| |
| \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions |
| \scanctxt |
| \catcode`\{=\other |
| \catcode`\}=\other |
| \catcode`\^^M=\other |
| \usembodybackslash |
| } |
| |
| \def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations |
| \scanctxt |
| \catcode`\\=0 |
| } |
| % why catcode 0 for \ in the above? To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes" |
| % for the single characters \ { }. Thus, we end up with the "commands" |
| % that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document. |
| % |
| % We already have @{ and @}. For @\, we define it here, and only for |
| % this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we |
| % define for @math can't be used with @macro calls): |
| % |
| \def\\{\normalbackslash}% |
| % |
| % We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does. |
| % But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a |
| % cedilla accent. Documents must use @comma{} instead. |
| % |
| % \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind. |
| |
| % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies. |
| % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N |
| % where N is the macro parameter number. |
| % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so |
| % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash. |
| % |
| {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active |
| @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash} |
| @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname} |
| } |
| \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash} |
| |
| \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 } |
| |
| \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx} |
| \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx} |
| |
| \def\macroxxx#1{% |
| \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist |
| \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments |
| \paramno=0\relax |
| \else |
| \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;% |
| \if\paramno>256\relax |
| \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments} |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname |
| \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}% |
| \else |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax |
| \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi |
| \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}% |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1% |
| \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}% |
| \fi |
| \begingroup \macrobodyctxt |
| \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody |
| \else \expandafter\parsemacbody |
| \fi} |
| |
| \parseargdef\unmacro{% |
| \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname |
| \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}% |
| \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0% |
| % Remove the macro name from \macrolist: |
| \begingroup |
| \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax |
| \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo |
| \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}% |
| \endgroup |
| \else |
| \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any |
| % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax. |
| % |
| \def\unmacrodo#1{% |
| \ifx #1\relax |
| % remove this |
| \else |
| \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a |
| % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by |
| % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed. |
| \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}} |
| \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs} |
| \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}} |
| \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}} |
| |
| % For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names. |
| \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@} |
| \catcode `@=11\relax |
| |
| % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist |
| % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH |
| % in the params list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If |
| % there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N |
| % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be |
| % defined `a la TeX in the macro body. |
| % |
| % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above). |
| % |
| % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions. |
| % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something |
| % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine |
| % it to # just before using the token list produced. |
| % |
| % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before |
| % the macro is used. |
| % |
| % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the |
| % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is |
| % processed again to replace the arguments. |
| % |
| % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the |
| % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of |
| % the catcode regime underwhich the body was input). |
| % |
| % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more |
| % arguments, no macro can have more than 256 arguments (else error). |
| \def\parsemargdef#1;{% |
| \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}% |
| \let\hash\relax |
| \let\xeatspaces\relax |
| \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,% |
| % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments |
| % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to |
| % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list |
| % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments |
| % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining |
| % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power. |
| \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else |
| \paramno0\relax |
| \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments |
| \fi |
| } |
| \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{% |
| \if#1;\let\next=\relax |
| \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx |
| \advance\paramno by 1 |
| \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname |
| {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}% |
| \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}% |
| \fi\next} |
| |
| \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{% |
| \if#1;\let\next=\relax |
| \else |
| \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@ |
| \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}% |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa |
| \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}% |
| % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we |
| % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an |
| % \xdef . |
| \expandafter\edef\tempa |
| {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}% |
| \advance\paramno by 1\relax |
| \fi\next} |
| |
| % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies. |
| % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.) |
| % |
| |
| \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode |
| \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro% |
| {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
| \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro% |
| {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}% |
| \catcode `\@=11\relax |
| |
| \let\endargs@\relax |
| \let\nil@\relax |
| \def\nilm@{\nil@}% |
| \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}% |
| |
| % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its |
| % definition. It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros |
| % macarg.ARGNAME |
| % |
| % #1 is the macro name |
| % #2 is the list of argument names |
| % #3 is the list of argument values |
| \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{% |
| \def\macargdeflist@{}% |
| \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion. |
| \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}% |
| \def\macroname{#1}% |
| \begingroup |
| \macroargctxt |
| \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}% |
| \def\@tempa{#3}% |
| \ifx\@tempa\empty |
| \setemptyargvalues@ |
| \else |
| \getargvals@@ |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % |
| \def\getargvals@@{% |
| \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ |
| % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty. |
| \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}% |
| \fi |
| \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ |
| \else |
| \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@ |
| % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg |
| % macros to empty. |
| \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ |
| \else |
| % pop current arg name into \@tempb |
| \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}% |
| \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}% |
| % pop current argument value into \@tempc |
| \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}% |
| \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}% |
| % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value. |
| % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd |
| \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}% |
| \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{% |
| \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}% |
| \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}% |
| \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@ |
| \let\next\getargvals@@ |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \next |
| } |
| |
| \def\push@#1#2{% |
| \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def |
| \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2% |
| \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{% |
| \expandafter#1#2}% |
| } |
| |
| % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result |
| % in macro \@tempa |
| \def\macvalstoargs@{% |
| % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed |
| % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument |
| % values into respective token registers. |
| % |
| % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering. |
| \begingroup |
| \paramno0\relax |
| % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument |
| % value into a new token list register \toks#N |
| \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,% |
| % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their |
| % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they |
| % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef . |
| \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}% |
| % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers |
| % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after |
| % group. |
| \expandafter |
| \endgroup |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}% |
| } |
| |
| \def\macargexpandinbody@{% |
| %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group. |
| \expandafter |
| \endgroup |
| \macargdeflist@ |
| % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result |
| % is in \@tempa . |
| \macvalstoargs@ |
| % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value |
| % with \@tempb . |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname |
| % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing |
| % \egroup . |
| \ifx\@tempb\gobble |
| \let\@tempc\relax |
| \else |
| \let\@tempc\egroup |
| \fi |
| % And now we do the real job: |
| \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}% |
| \@tempd |
| } |
| |
| \def\putargsintokens@#1,{% |
| \if#1;\let\next\relax |
| \else |
| \let\next\putargsintokens@ |
| % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary |
| % alias \@tempb . |
| \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno |
| % Then we place the argument value into that token list register. |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname |
| \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}% |
| \advance\paramno by 1\relax |
| \fi |
| \next |
| } |
| |
| % Save the token stack pointer into macro #1 |
| \def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi}} |
| % Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1 |
| \def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi#1\relax} |
| % newtoks that can be used non \outer . |
| \def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@ 5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi} |
| |
| % Tailing missing arguments are set to empty |
| \def\setemptyargvalues@{% |
| \ifx\paramlist\nilm@ |
| \let\next\macargexpandinbody@ |
| \else |
| \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@ |
| \let\next\setemptyargvalues@ |
| \fi |
| \next |
| } |
| |
| \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{% |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{% |
| \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}% |
| \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@ |
| \def\paramlist{#2}% |
| } |
| |
| % #1 is the element target macro |
| % #2 is the list macro |
| % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value |
| \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% |
| \def#1{#3}% |
| \def#2{#4}% |
| } |
| \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{% |
| \long\def#1{#3}% |
| \long\def#2{#4}% |
| } |
| |
| % This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and |
| % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments. |
| % Much magic with \expandafter here. |
| % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file |
| % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group. |
| % |
| \def\defmacro{% |
| \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars |
| \ifrecursive |
| \ifcase\paramno |
| % 0 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
| \or % 1 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
| \noexpand\braceorline |
| \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
| \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
| \else |
| \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
| \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
| \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
| \expandafter\expandafter |
| \expandafter\xdef |
| \expandafter\expandafter |
| \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
| \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}% |
| \else % 10 or more |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% |
| }% |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \ifcase\paramno |
| % 0 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
| \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
| \or % 1 |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
| \noexpand\braceorline |
| \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}% |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{% |
| \egroup |
| \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
| \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
| \else % at most 9 |
| \ifnum\paramno<10\relax |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt |
| \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}% |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{% |
| \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}% |
| \expandafter\expandafter |
| \expandafter\xdef |
| \expandafter\expandafter |
| \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname |
| \paramlist{% |
| \egroup |
| \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}% |
| \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}% |
| \else % 10 or more: |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{% |
| \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}% |
| }% |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp |
| \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi} |
| |
| \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax |
| |
| \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}} |
| |
| % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a |
| % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole |
| % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence |
| % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg). |
| % |
| \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx} |
| \def\braceorlinexxx{% |
| \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else |
| \expandafter\parsearg |
| \fi \macnamexxx} |
| |
| |
| % @alias. |
| % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal |
| % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing. |
| % |
| \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx} |
| \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax} |
| \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{% |
| {% |
| \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty |
| \addtomacrolist{#1}% |
| \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}% |
| }% |
| \next |
| } |
| |
| |
| \message{cross references,} |
| |
| \newwrite\auxfile |
| \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known. |
| \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known. |
| |
| % @inforef is relatively simple. |
| \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**} |
| \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{% |
| \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}}, |
| node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}} |
| |
| % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in |
| % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and |
| % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like: |
| % @node foo , bar , ... |
| % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse} |
| % |
| % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this: |
| % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs |
| \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse} |
| \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}} |
| |
| \let\nwnode=\node |
| \let\lastnode=\empty |
| |
| % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the |
| % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing). |
| % |
| \def\donoderef#1{% |
| \ifx\lastnode\empty\else |
| \setref{\lastnode}{#1}% |
| \global\let\lastnode=\empty |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point. |
| % |
| \newcount\savesfregister |
| % |
| \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi} |
| \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi} |
| \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces} |
| |
| % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an |
| % anchor), which consists of three parts: |
| % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection, |
| % or the anchor name. |
| % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or |
| % empty for anchors. |
| % 3) NAME-pg - the page number. |
| % |
| % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of |
| % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here: |
| % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats. |
| % |
| \def\setref#1#2{% |
| \pdfmkdest{#1}% |
| \iflinks |
| {% |
| \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them |
| \edef\writexrdef##1##2{% |
| \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef |
| ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef |
| }% |
| \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}% |
| \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }% |
| \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc. |
| \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout |
| }% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used |
| % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified. |
| % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title |
| % variable, now it's official. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \ifx\temp\onword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname |
| = \empty |
| \else\ifx\temp\offword |
| \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname |
| = \relax |
| \else |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp', |
| must be on|off}% |
| \fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % |
| % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is |
| % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed |
| % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed |
| % manual. All but the node name can be omitted. |
| % |
| \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
| \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
| \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]} |
| % |
| \newbox\toprefbox |
| \newbox\printedrefnamebox |
| \newbox\infofilenamebox |
| \newbox\printedmanualbox |
| % |
| \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup |
| \unsepspaces |
| % |
| % Get args without leading/trailing spaces. |
| \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}% |
| \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}% |
| % |
| \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}% |
| \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}% |
| % |
| \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}% |
| \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}% |
| % |
| % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in |
| % the @xref, figure out what we want to use. |
| \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt |
| % No printed node name was explicitly given. |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax |
| % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets. |
| \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
| \else |
| % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside |
| % the square brackets if we have it. |
| \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt |
| % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name. |
| \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
| \else |
| \ifhavexrefs |
| % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values. |
| \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}% |
| \else |
| % Otherwise just copy the Info node name. |
| \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}% |
| \fi% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Make link in pdf output. |
| \ifpdf |
| {\indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \makevalueexpandable |
| % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _ |
| % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in |
| % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename. |
| \getfilename{#4}% |
| % |
| % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing |
| % spaces in #1, which should be ignored. |
| \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}% |
| \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty |
| \def\pdfxrefdest{Top}% no empty targets |
| \else |
| \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest % escape PDF special chars |
| \fi |
| % |
| \leavevmode |
| \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}% |
| \ifnum\filenamelength>0 |
| goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}% |
| \else |
| goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}% |
| \fi |
| }% |
| \setcolor{\linkcolor}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2" |
| % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the |
| % LABEL-title being set to a magic string. |
| {% |
| % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to |
| % include an _ in the xref name, etc. |
| \indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle |
| \csname XR#1-title\endcsname |
| }% |
| \iffloat\Xthisreftitle |
| % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref, |
| % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2". |
| \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt |
| \refx{#1-snt}{}% |
| \else |
| \printedrefname |
| \fi |
| % |
| % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append |
| % "in MANUALNAME". |
| \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt |
| \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| % node/anchor (non-float) references. |
| % |
| % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert |
| % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not |
| % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals |
| % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens, |
| % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name |
| % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time. |
| % |
| \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt |
| % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name. |
| % |
| \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}% |
| % |
| \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt |
| % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no |
| % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as |
| % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else. |
| % |
| \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}% |
| % |
| \else |
| % Reference within this manual. |
| % |
| % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the |
| % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand |
| % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of |
| % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the |
| % printing, back off for the \refx-pg. |
| {\turnoffactive |
| % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for |
| % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be. |
| \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}% |
| \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi |
| }% |
| % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden. |
| \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname |
| % |
| % But we always want a comma and a space: |
| ,\space |
| % |
| % output the `page 3'. |
| \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}% |
| \fi\fi |
| \fi |
| \endlink |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice). |
| % |
| % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither |
| % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply |
| % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual. |
| % |
| % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the |
| % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in |
| % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less |
| % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g., |
| % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice. |
| % |
| % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every |
| % reference, since the current font is indeterminate. |
| % |
| \def\crossmanualxref#1{% |
| \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}% |
| \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}% |
| \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty? |
| \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top? |
| \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| #1% |
| } |
| |
| % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref |
| % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily, |
| % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly |
| % one that Bob is working on :). |
| % |
| \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]} |
| |
| % Things referred to by \setref. |
| % |
| \def\Ynothing{} |
| \def\Yomitfromtoc{} |
| \def\Ynumbered{% |
| \ifnum\secno=0 |
| \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno |
| \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
| \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno |
| \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
| \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
| \else |
| \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| } |
| \def\Yappendix{% |
| \ifnum\secno=0 |
| \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}% |
| \else \ifnum\subsecno=0 |
| \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno |
| \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0 |
| \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno |
| \else |
| \putwordSection@tie |
| @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME. |
| % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward. |
| % |
| \def\refx#1#2{% |
| {% |
| \indexnofonts |
| \otherbackslash |
| \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX |
| \csname XR#1\endcsname |
| }% |
| \ifx\thisrefX\relax |
| % If not defined, say something at least. |
| \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright |
| \iflinks |
| \ifhavexrefs |
| {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value |
| \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}% |
| \else |
| \ifwarnedxrefs\else |
| \global\warnedxrefstrue |
| \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}% |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \fi |
| \else |
| % It's defined, so just use it. |
| \thisrefX |
| \fi |
| #2% Output the suffix in any case. |
| } |
| |
| % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's |
| % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid |
| % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do. |
| % |
| \def\xrdef#1#2{% |
| {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current |
| % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these |
| % mess up the control sequence name. |
| \indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \xdef\safexrefname{#1}% |
| }% |
| % |
| \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref |
| % |
| % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float? |
| \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname |
| % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype. |
| \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist |
| \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname |
| % |
| % Is this the first time we've seen this float type? |
| \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax |
| \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do |
| \else |
| % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list. |
| \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE, |
| % for later use in \listoffloats. |
| \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0 |
| {\safexrefname}}% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists. |
| % |
| \def\tryauxfile{% |
| \openin 1 \jobname.aux |
| \ifeof 1 \else |
| \readdatafile{aux}% |
| \global\havexrefstrue |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| } |
| |
| \def\setupdatafile{% |
| \catcode`\^^@=\other |
| \catcode`\^^A=\other |
| \catcode`\^^B=\other |
| \catcode`\^^C=\other |
| \catcode`\^^D=\other |
| \catcode`\^^E=\other |
| \catcode`\^^F=\other |
| \catcode`\^^G=\other |
| \catcode`\^^H=\other |
| \catcode`\^^K=\other |
| \catcode`\^^L=\other |
| \catcode`\^^N=\other |
| \catcode`\^^P=\other |
| \catcode`\^^Q=\other |
| \catcode`\^^R=\other |
| \catcode`\^^S=\other |
| \catcode`\^^T=\other |
| \catcode`\^^U=\other |
| \catcode`\^^V=\other |
| \catcode`\^^W=\other |
| \catcode`\^^X=\other |
| \catcode`\^^Z=\other |
| \catcode`\^^[=\other |
| \catcode`\^^\=\other |
| \catcode`\^^]=\other |
| \catcode`\^^^=\other |
| \catcode`\^^_=\other |
| % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc. |
| % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't |
| % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore, |
| % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^ |
| % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat |
| % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first |
| % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could |
| % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't. |
| % |
| % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat: |
| % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter |
| % and then to call \auxhat in \setq. |
| % |
| \catcode`\^=\other |
| % |
| % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but... |
| \catcode`\~=\other |
| \catcode`\[=\other |
| \catcode`\]=\other |
| \catcode`\"=\other |
| \catcode`\_=\other |
| \catcode`\|=\other |
| \catcode`\<=\other |
| \catcode`\>=\other |
| \catcode`\$=\other |
| \catcode`\#=\other |
| \catcode`\&=\other |
| \catcode`\%=\other |
| \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off |
| % |
| % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \ |
| % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than |
| % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \ |
| % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value* |
| % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that |
| % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for |
| % now. --karl, 15jan04. |
| \catcode`\\=\other |
| % |
| % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters. |
| {% |
| \count1=128 |
| \def\loop{% |
| \catcode\count1=\other |
| \advance\count1 by 1 |
| \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi |
| }% |
| }% |
| % |
| % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces. |
| \catcode`\{=1 |
| \catcode`\}=2 |
| \catcode`\@=0 |
| } |
| |
| \def\readdatafile#1{% |
| \begingroup |
| \setupdatafile |
| \input\jobname.#1 |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| |
| \message{insertions,} |
| % including footnotes. |
| |
| \newcount \footnoteno |
| |
| % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is |
| % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a |
| % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is |
| % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a |
| % space to prevent strange expansion errors.) |
| \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 } |
| |
| % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only. |
| \let\footnotestyle=\comment |
| |
| {\catcode `\@=11 |
| % |
| % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain. |
| \gdef\footnote{% |
| \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne |
| \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}% |
| % |
| % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the |
| % extra spacing after we do the footnote number. |
| \let\@sf\empty |
| \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi |
| % |
| % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number. |
| \unskip |
| \thisfootno\@sf |
| \dofootnote |
| }% |
| |
| % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the |
| % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general. |
| % |
| % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses |
| % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when |
| % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96. |
| % |
| \gdef\dofootnote{% |
| \insert\footins\bgroup |
| % |
| % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot |
| % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.) |
| \let\footnote=\errfootnotenest |
| % |
| % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the |
| % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment. |
| % So reset some parameters. |
| \hsize=\pagewidth |
| \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty |
| \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes |
| \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox |
| \floatingpenalty\@MM |
| \leftskip\z@skip |
| \rightskip\z@skip |
| \spaceskip\z@skip |
| \xspaceskip\z@skip |
| \parindent\defaultparindent |
| % |
| \smallfonts \rm |
| % |
| % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears |
| % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use |
| % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote |
| % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style). |
| \let\noindent = \relax |
| % |
| % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the |
| % footnote extends for more than one paragraph. |
| \everypar = {\hang}% |
| \textindent{\thisfootno}% |
| % |
| % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this |
| % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it |
| % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote. |
| \footstrut |
| % |
| % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine. |
| \futurelet\next\fo@t |
| } |
| }%end \catcode `\@=11 |
| |
| \def\errfootnotenest{% |
| \errhelp=\EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex, |
| even though they work in makeinfo; sorry} |
| } |
| |
| \def\errfootnoteheading{% |
| \errhelp=\EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Footnotes in chapters, sections, etc., are not supported} |
| } |
| |
| % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create |
| % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion |
| % would be lost. |
| % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote |
| % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished. |
| % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03. |
| % |
| % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro. |
| % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled |
| % out prematurely. |
| % |
| \def\startsavinginserts{% |
| \ifx \insert\ptexinsert |
| \let\insert\saveinsert |
| \else |
| \let\checkinserts\relax |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and |
| % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}. |
| % |
| \def\saveinsert#1{% |
| \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}% |
| \afterassignment\next |
| % swallow the left brace |
| \let\temp = |
| } |
| \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}} |
| \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1} |
| |
| \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi} |
| |
| \def\placesaveins#1{% |
| \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname |
| {\box#1}% |
| } |
| |
| % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other: |
| { |
| \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-) |
| \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{} |
| } |
| |
| % initialization: |
| \def\newsaveins #1{% |
| \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}% |
| \next |
| } |
| \def\newsaveinsX #1{% |
| \csname newbox\endcsname #1% |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts |
| \checksaveins #1}% |
| } |
| |
| % initialize: |
| \let\checkinserts\empty |
| \newsaveins\footins |
| \newsaveins\margin |
| |
| |
| % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this. |
| % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain. |
| % |
| % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image |
| % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get |
| % undone and the next image would fail. |
| \openin 1 = epsf.tex |
| \ifeof 1 \else |
| % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in |
| % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan). |
| \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }% |
| \input epsf.tex |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| % |
| % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex. |
| \newif\ifwarnednoepsf |
| \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to |
| work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get |
| it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.} |
| % |
| \def\image#1{% |
| \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined |
| \ifwarnednoepsf \else |
| \errhelp = \noepsfhelp |
| \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}% |
| \global\warnednoepsftrue |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish |
| \fi |
| } |
| % |
| % Arguments to @image: |
| % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension. |
| % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height. |
| % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text. |
| % #5 is (ignored optional) extension. |
| % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff. |
| \newif\ifimagevmode |
| \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup |
| \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example |
| \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names |
| % If the image is by itself, center it. |
| \ifvmode |
| \imagevmodetrue |
| \else \ifx\centersub\centerV |
| % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space |
| \imagevmodetrue |
| \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev |
| \fi\fi |
| % |
| \ifimagevmode |
| \nobreak\medskip |
| % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert |
| % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space |
| % above and below. |
| \nobreak\vskip\parskip |
| \nobreak |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing |
| % environment such as @quotation is respected. |
| % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the |
| % normal paragraph indentation. |
| % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't |
| % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and |
| % eradicate the centering. |
| \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi |
| % |
| % Output the image. |
| \ifpdf |
| \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}% |
| \else |
| % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure. |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi |
| \epsfbox{#1.eps}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| \ifimagevmode |
| \medskip % space after a standalone image |
| \fi |
| \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| |
| % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables, |
| % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the |
| % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future. |
| % |
| \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish} |
| |
| % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it. |
| \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,} |
| |
| % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically |
| % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted, |
| % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to. |
| % |
| % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to |
| % be referable. |
| % |
| % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It |
| % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom). |
| % |
| % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each |
| % chapter-level command. |
| \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty |
| % |
| \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% |
| \let\thiscaption=\empty |
| \let\thisshortcaption=\empty |
| % |
| % don't lose footnotes inside @float. |
| % |
| % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an |
| % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04 |
| % |
| \startsavinginserts |
| % |
| % We can't be used inside a paragraph. |
| \par |
| % |
| \vtop\bgroup |
| \def\floattype{#1}% |
| \def\floatlabel{#2}% |
| \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet. |
| % |
| \ifx\floattype\empty |
| \let\safefloattype=\empty |
| \else |
| {% |
| % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, |
| % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. |
| \indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% |
| }% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type. |
| \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
| % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1, |
| % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.) |
| % |
| \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname |
| \global\advance\floatno by 1 |
| % |
| {% |
| % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the |
| % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float |
| % labels (which have a completely different output format) from |
| % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the |
| % lists of floats. |
| % |
| \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}% |
| \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}% |
| }% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % start with \parskip glue, I guess. |
| \vskip\parskip |
| % |
| % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section. |
| \restorefirstparagraphindent |
| } |
| |
| % we have these possibilities: |
| % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap |
| % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1 |
| % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap |
| % @float Foo & no caption: Foo |
| % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap |
| % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1 |
| % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap |
| % @float & no caption: |
| % |
| \def\Efloat{% |
| \let\floatident = \empty |
| % |
| % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first. |
| \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi |
| % |
| % If we have an xref label, the number comes next. |
| \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
| \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first. |
| \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}% |
| \fi |
| % the number. |
| \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in |
| % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again. |
| \let\captionline = \floatident |
| % |
| \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else |
| \ifx\floatident\empty \else |
| \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between |
| \fi |
| % |
| % caption text. |
| \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}% |
| \fi |
| % |
| % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before. |
| % Eventually this needs to become an \insert. |
| \ifx\captionline\empty \else |
| \vskip.5\parskip |
| \captionline |
| % |
| % Space below caption. |
| \vskip\parskip |
| \fi |
| % |
| % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this |
| % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint. |
| \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else |
| % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as |
| % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short |
| % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing. |
| {% |
| \atdummies |
| % |
| % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M |
| % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so |
| % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file. |
| \scanexp{% |
| \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{% |
| \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty |
| \thiscaption |
| \else |
| \thisshortcaption |
| \fi |
| }% |
| }% |
| \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident |
| \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}% |
| }% |
| \fi |
| \egroup % end of \vtop |
| % |
| % place the captured inserts |
| % |
| % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning |
| % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly |
| % float. --kasal, 26may04 |
| % |
| \checkinserts |
| } |
| |
| % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either. |
| % |
| \def\appendtomacro#1#2{% |
| \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}% |
| } |
| |
| % @caption, @shortcaption |
| % |
| \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption} |
| \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption} |
| \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption} |
| \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}} |
| |
| % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are |
| % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno. |
| \def\getfloatno#1{% |
| \ifx#1\relax |
| % Haven't seen this figure type before. |
| \csname newcount\endcsname #1% |
| % |
| % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap. |
| \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos |
| \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }% |
| \fi |
| \let\floatno#1% |
| } |
| |
| % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref |
| % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we |
| % first read the @float command. |
| % |
| \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}% |
| |
| % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can |
| % distinguish floats from other xref types. |
| \def\floatmagic{!!float!!} |
| |
| % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional |
| % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic |
| % \lastsection value which we \setref above. |
| % |
| \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish} |
| % |
| % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the |
| % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2. |
| % |
| \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{% |
| \def\temp{#1}% |
| \def\iffloattype{#2}% |
| \ifx\temp\floatmagic |
| } |
| |
| % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\listoffloats{% |
| \def\floattype{#1}% floattype |
| {% |
| % the floattype might have accents or other special characters, |
| % but we need to use it in a control sequence name. |
| \indexnofonts |
| \turnoffactive |
| \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}% |
| }% |
| % |
| % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE. |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax |
| \ifhavexrefs |
| % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo. |
| \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}% |
| \fi |
| \else |
| \begingroup |
| \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc |
| \let\do=\listoffloatsdo |
| \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname |
| \endgroup |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the |
| % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the |
| % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which |
| % has the text we're supposed to typeset here. |
| % |
| % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since |
| % they won't appear in the aux file). |
| % |
| \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish} |
| \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{% |
| % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just |
| % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the |
| % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link |
| % in pdf output. |
| \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}% |
| % |
| % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index. |
| \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}% |
| \writeentry |
| }} |
| |
| |
| \message{localization,} |
| |
| % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very |
| % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language |
| % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation. |
| % |
| { |
| \catcode`\_ = \active |
| \globaldefs=1 |
| \parseargdef\documentlanguage{% |
| \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX. |
| % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists. |
| \let_ = \normalunderscore % normal _ character for filename test |
| \openin 1 txi-#1.tex |
| \ifeof 1 |
| \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore #1_\finish |
| \else |
| \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist |
| \input txi-#1.tex |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| \endgroup % end raw TeX |
| } |
| % |
| % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist, |
| % try txi-de.tex. |
| % |
| \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{% |
| \openin 1 txi-#1.tex |
| \ifeof 1 |
| \errhelp = \nolanghelp |
| \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}% |
| \else |
| \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist |
| \input txi-#1.tex |
| \fi |
| \closein 1 |
| } |
| }% end of special _ catcode |
| % |
| \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or |
| is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current |
| directory should work if nowhere else does.} |
| |
| % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the |
| % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and |
| % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin. |
| % |
| % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built. |
| % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g., |
| % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log. |
| % |
| % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all |
| % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in |
| % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the |
| % accented characters problem.) |
| % |
| \catcode`@=11 |
| \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{% |
| % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX. |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax |
| \message{no patterns for #1}% |
| \else |
| \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname |
| \fi |
| % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless. |
| \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax |
| \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax |
| } |
| |
| % Helpers for encodings. |
| % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number. |
| % |
| \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{% |
| \count255=128 |
| \loop\ifnum\count255<256 |
| \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax |
| \advance\count255 by 1 |
| \repeat |
| } |
| |
| \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{% |
| \count255=128 |
| \loop\ifnum\count255<256 |
| \catcode\count255=#1\relax |
| \advance\count255 by 1 |
| \repeat |
| } |
| |
| % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters |
| % according to the specified encoding. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\documentencoding{% |
| % Encoding being declared for the document. |
| \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}% |
| % |
| % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able |
| % to compare them with \ifx. |
| \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}% |
| \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}% |
| \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}% |
| \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}% |
| \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}% |
| % |
| \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii |
| \asciichardefs |
| % |
| \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode\active |
| \lattwochardefs |
| % |
| \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode\active |
| \latonechardefs |
| % |
| \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode\active |
| \latninechardefs |
| % |
| \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode\active |
| \utfeightchardefs |
| % |
| \else |
| \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}% |
| % |
| \fi % utfeight |
| \fi % latnine |
| \fi % latone |
| \fi % lattwo |
| \fi % ascii |
| } |
| |
| % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available |
| % the default font encoding (OT1). |
| % |
| \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}} |
| |
| % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference. |
| \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi} |
| |
| % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be |
| % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of |
| % macros containing the character definitions. |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode\active |
| % |
| % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions. |
| \def\latonechardefs{% |
| \gdef^^a0{\tie} |
| \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown} |
| \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}} |
| \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}} |
| \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} |
| \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}} |
| \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}} |
| \gdef^^a7{\S} |
| \gdef^^a8{\"{}} |
| \gdef^^a9{\copyright} |
| \gdef^^aa{\ordf} |
| \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft} |
| \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$} |
| \gdef^^ad{\-} |
| \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol} |
| \gdef^^af{\={}} |
| % |
| \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} |
| \gdef^^b1{$\pm$} |
| \gdef^^b2{$^2$} |
| \gdef^^b3{$^3$} |
| \gdef^^b4{\'{}} |
| \gdef^^b5{$\mu$} |
| \gdef^^b6{\P} |
| % |
| \gdef^^b7{$^.$} |
| \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } |
| \gdef^^b9{$^1$} |
| \gdef^^ba{\ordm} |
| % |
| \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright} |
| \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$} |
| \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$} |
| \gdef^^be{$3\over4$} |
| \gdef^^bf{\questiondown} |
| % |
| \gdef^^c0{\`A} |
| \gdef^^c1{\'A} |
| \gdef^^c2{\^A} |
| \gdef^^c3{\~A} |
| \gdef^^c4{\"A} |
| \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A} |
| \gdef^^c6{\AE} |
| \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} |
| \gdef^^c8{\`E} |
| \gdef^^c9{\'E} |
| \gdef^^ca{\^E} |
| \gdef^^cb{\"E} |
| \gdef^^cc{\`I} |
| \gdef^^cd{\'I} |
| \gdef^^ce{\^I} |
| \gdef^^cf{\"I} |
| % |
| \gdef^^d0{\DH} |
| \gdef^^d1{\~N} |
| \gdef^^d2{\`O} |
| \gdef^^d3{\'O} |
| \gdef^^d4{\^O} |
| \gdef^^d5{\~O} |
| \gdef^^d6{\"O} |
| \gdef^^d7{$\times$} |
| \gdef^^d8{\O} |
| \gdef^^d9{\`U} |
| \gdef^^da{\'U} |
| \gdef^^db{\^U} |
| \gdef^^dc{\"U} |
| \gdef^^dd{\'Y} |
| \gdef^^de{\TH} |
| \gdef^^df{\ss} |
| % |
| \gdef^^e0{\`a} |
| \gdef^^e1{\'a} |
| \gdef^^e2{\^a} |
| \gdef^^e3{\~a} |
| \gdef^^e4{\"a} |
| \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a} |
| \gdef^^e6{\ae} |
| \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} |
| \gdef^^e8{\`e} |
| \gdef^^e9{\'e} |
| \gdef^^ea{\^e} |
| \gdef^^eb{\"e} |
| \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}} |
| \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}} |
| \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}} |
| \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}} |
| % |
| \gdef^^f0{\dh} |
| \gdef^^f1{\~n} |
| \gdef^^f2{\`o} |
| \gdef^^f3{\'o} |
| \gdef^^f4{\^o} |
| \gdef^^f5{\~o} |
| \gdef^^f6{\"o} |
| \gdef^^f7{$\div$} |
| \gdef^^f8{\o} |
| \gdef^^f9{\`u} |
| \gdef^^fa{\'u} |
| \gdef^^fb{\^u} |
| \gdef^^fc{\"u} |
| \gdef^^fd{\'y} |
| \gdef^^fe{\th} |
| \gdef^^ff{\"y} |
| } |
| |
| % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions. |
| \def\latninechardefs{% |
| % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1. |
| \latonechardefs |
| % |
| \gdef^^a4{\euro} |
| \gdef^^a6{\v S} |
| \gdef^^a8{\v s} |
| \gdef^^b4{\v Z} |
| \gdef^^b8{\v z} |
| \gdef^^bc{\OE} |
| \gdef^^bd{\oe} |
| \gdef^^be{\"Y} |
| } |
| |
| % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions. |
| \def\lattwochardefs{% |
| \gdef^^a0{\tie} |
| \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}} |
| \gdef^^a2{\u{}} |
| \gdef^^a3{\L} |
| \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}} |
| \gdef^^a5{\v L} |
| \gdef^^a6{\'S} |
| \gdef^^a7{\S} |
| \gdef^^a8{\"{}} |
| \gdef^^a9{\v S} |
| \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S} |
| \gdef^^ab{\v T} |
| \gdef^^ac{\'Z} |
| \gdef^^ad{\-} |
| \gdef^^ae{\v Z} |
| \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z} |
| % |
| \gdef^^b0{\textdegree} |
| \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}} |
| \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }} |
| \gdef^^b3{\l} |
| \gdef^^b4{\'{}} |
| \gdef^^b5{\v l} |
| \gdef^^b6{\'s} |
| \gdef^^b7{\v{}} |
| \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ } |
| \gdef^^b9{\v s} |
| \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s} |
| \gdef^^bb{\v t} |
| \gdef^^bc{\'z} |
| \gdef^^bd{\H{}} |
| \gdef^^be{\v z} |
| \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z} |
| % |
| \gdef^^c0{\'R} |
| \gdef^^c1{\'A} |
| \gdef^^c2{\^A} |
| \gdef^^c3{\u A} |
| \gdef^^c4{\"A} |
| \gdef^^c5{\'L} |
| \gdef^^c6{\'C} |
| \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C} |
| \gdef^^c8{\v C} |
| \gdef^^c9{\'E} |
| \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}} |
| \gdef^^cb{\"E} |
| \gdef^^cc{\v E} |
| \gdef^^cd{\'I} |
| \gdef^^ce{\^I} |
| \gdef^^cf{\v D} |
| % |
| \gdef^^d0{\DH} |
| \gdef^^d1{\'N} |
| \gdef^^d2{\v N} |
| \gdef^^d3{\'O} |
| \gdef^^d4{\^O} |
| \gdef^^d5{\H O} |
| \gdef^^d6{\"O} |
| \gdef^^d7{$\times$} |
| \gdef^^d8{\v R} |
| \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U} |
| \gdef^^da{\'U} |
| \gdef^^db{\H U} |
| \gdef^^dc{\"U} |
| \gdef^^dd{\'Y} |
| \gdef^^de{\cedilla T} |
| \gdef^^df{\ss} |
| % |
| \gdef^^e0{\'r} |
| \gdef^^e1{\'a} |
| \gdef^^e2{\^a} |
| \gdef^^e3{\u a} |
| \gdef^^e4{\"a} |
| \gdef^^e5{\'l} |
| \gdef^^e6{\'c} |
| \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c} |
| \gdef^^e8{\v c} |
| \gdef^^e9{\'e} |
| \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}} |
| \gdef^^eb{\"e} |
| \gdef^^ec{\v e} |
| \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}} |
| \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}} |
| \gdef^^ef{\v d} |
| % |
| \gdef^^f0{\dh} |
| \gdef^^f1{\'n} |
| \gdef^^f2{\v n} |
| \gdef^^f3{\'o} |
| \gdef^^f4{\^o} |
| \gdef^^f5{\H o} |
| \gdef^^f6{\"o} |
| \gdef^^f7{$\div$} |
| \gdef^^f8{\v r} |
| \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u} |
| \gdef^^fa{\'u} |
| \gdef^^fb{\H u} |
| \gdef^^fc{\"u} |
| \gdef^^fd{\'y} |
| \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t} |
| \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}} |
| } |
| |
| % UTF-8 character definitions. |
| % |
| % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some |
| % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by |
| % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team. |
| % |
| \newcount\countUTFx |
| \newcount\countUTFy |
| \newcount\countUTFz |
| |
| \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter |
| \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname} |
| % |
| \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter |
| \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname} |
| % |
| \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter |
| \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname} |
| |
| \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{% |
| \ifx #1\relax |
| \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}% |
| \else |
| \expandafter #1% |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\~13 |
| \catcode`\"12 |
| |
| \def\UTFviiiLoop{% |
| \global\catcode\countUTFx\active |
| \uccode`\~\countUTFx |
| \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}% |
| \advance\countUTFx by 1 |
| \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy |
| \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop |
| \fi} |
| |
| \countUTFx = "C2 |
| \countUTFy = "E0 |
| \def\UTFviiiTmp{% |
| \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}} |
| \UTFviiiLoop |
| |
| \countUTFx = "E0 |
| \countUTFy = "F0 |
| \def\UTFviiiTmp{% |
| \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}} |
| \UTFviiiLoop |
| |
| \countUTFx = "F0 |
| \countUTFy = "F4 |
| \def\UTFviiiTmp{% |
| \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}} |
| \UTFviiiLoop |
| \endgroup |
| |
| \def\globallet{\global\let} % save some \expandafter's below |
| |
| % @U{xxxx} to produce U+xxxx, if we support it. |
| \def\U#1{% |
| \expandafter\ifx\csname uni:#1\endcsname \relax |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Unicode character U+#1 not supported, sorry}% |
| \else |
| \csname uni:#1\endcsname |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| \begingroup |
| \catcode`\"=12 |
| \catcode`\<=12 |
| \catcode`\.=12 |
| \catcode`\,=12 |
| \catcode`\;=12 |
| \catcode`\!=12 |
| \catcode`\~=13 |
| \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{% |
| \countUTFz = "#1\relax |
| %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}% |
| \begingroup |
| \parseXMLCharref |
| \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{% |
| \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}% |
| \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{% |
| \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}% |
| \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{% |
| \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}% |
| \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter |
| \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter |
| \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}% |
| % define an additional control sequence for this code point. |
| \expandafter\globallet\csname uni:#1\endcsname \UTFviiiTmp |
| \endgroup} |
| |
| \gdef\parseXMLCharref{% |
| \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax |
| \errhelp = \EMsimple |
| \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}% |
| \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax |
| \parseUTFviiiA,% |
| \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,% |
| \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax |
| \parseUTFviiiA;% |
| \parseUTFviiiA,% |
| \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}% |
| \else |
| \parseUTFviiiA;% |
| \parseUTFviiiA,% |
| \parseUTFviiiA!% |
| \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}% |
| \fi\fi\fi |
| } |
| |
| \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{% |
| \countUTFx = \countUTFz |
| \divide\countUTFz by 64 |
| \countUTFy = \countUTFz |
| \multiply\countUTFz by 64 |
| \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz |
| \advance\countUTFx by 128 |
| \uccode `#1\countUTFx |
| \countUTFz = \countUTFy} |
| |
| \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{% |
| \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax |
| \uccode `#3\countUTFz |
| \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}} |
| \endgroup |
| |
| \def\utfeightchardefs{% |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result} |
| |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point} |
| \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv} |
| }% end of \utfeightchardefs |
| |
| |
| % US-ASCII character definitions. |
| \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done |
| \relax |
| } |
| |
| % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with |
| % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a |
| % document encoding. |
| % |
| \setnonasciicharscatcode \other |
| |
| |
| \message{formatting,} |
| |
| \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt |
| |
| \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt |
| \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt |
| \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt |
| |
| % Prevent underfull vbox error messages. |
| \vbadness = 10000 |
| |
| % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either. |
| \hbadness = 6666 |
| |
| % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans. |
| \widowpenalty=10000 |
| \clubpenalty=10000 |
| |
| % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're |
| % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of |
| % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on |
| % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set. |
| % |
| \def\setemergencystretch{% |
| \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined |
| % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway. |
| \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}% |
| \else |
| \emergencystretch = .15\hsize |
| \fi |
| } |
| |
| % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth; |
| % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip; |
| % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width. |
| % |
| % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define |
| % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip. |
| % |
| \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{% |
| \voffset = #3\relax |
| \topskip = #6\relax |
| \splittopskip = \topskip |
| % |
| \vsize = #1\relax |
| \advance\vsize by \topskip |
| \outervsize = \vsize |
| \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin |
| \pageheight = \vsize |
| % |
| \hsize = #2\relax |
| \outerhsize = \hsize |
| \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in |
| \pagewidth = \hsize |
| % |
| \normaloffset = #4\relax |
| \bindingoffset = #5\relax |
| % |
| \ifpdf |
| \pdfpageheight #7\relax |
| \pdfpagewidth #8\relax |
| % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of |
| % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with. |
| \pdfhorigin = 1 true in |
| \pdfvorigin = 1 true in |
| \fi |
| % |
| \setleading{\textleading} |
| % |
| \parindent = \defaultparindent |
| \setemergencystretch |
| } |
| |
| % @letterpaper (the default). |
| \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
| \textleading = 13.2pt |
| % |
| % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even. |
| \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines |
| {\voffset}{.25in}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{36pt}% |
| {11in}{8.5in}% |
| }} |
| |
| % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size. |
| \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt |
| \textleading = 12pt |
| % |
| \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}% |
| {-.2in}{0in}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{16pt}% |
| {9.25in}{7in}% |
| % |
| \lispnarrowing = 0.3in |
| \tolerance = 700 |
| \hfuzz = 1pt |
| \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
| \defbodyindent = .5cm |
| }} |
| |
| % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size. |
| % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.) |
| \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt |
| \textleading = 12pt |
| % |
| \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}% |
| {-.2in}{-.4in}% |
| {0pt}{14pt}% |
| {9in}{6in}% |
| % |
| \lispnarrowing = 0.25in |
| \tolerance = 700 |
| \hfuzz = 1pt |
| \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
| \defbodyindent = .4cm |
| }} |
| |
| % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper. |
| \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
| \textleading = 13.2pt |
| % |
| % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050 |
| % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm. |
| % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust |
| % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then |
| % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in |
| % your texinfo source file like this: |
| % @tex |
| % \global\normaloffset = -6mm |
| % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm |
| % @end tex |
| \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines |
| {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
| {297mm}{210mm}% |
| % |
| \tolerance = 700 |
| \hfuzz = 1pt |
| \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
| \defbodyindent = 5mm |
| }} |
| |
| % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper. |
| % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000. |
| % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small. |
| \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt |
| \textleading = 12.5pt |
| % |
| \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}% |
| {\voffset}{\hoffset}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{8pt}% |
| {210mm}{148mm}% |
| % |
| \lispnarrowing = 0.2in |
| \tolerance = 800 |
| \hfuzz = 1.2pt |
| \contentsrightmargin = 0pt |
| \defbodyindent = 2mm |
| \tableindent = 12mm |
| }} |
| |
| % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper. |
| \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \afourpaper |
| \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}% |
| {\voffset}{4.6mm}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
| {297mm}{210mm}% |
| % |
| % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper. |
| \globaldefs = 0 |
| }} |
| |
| % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format. |
| \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1 |
| \afourpaper |
| \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}% |
| {\voffset}{-2.95mm}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{7mm}% |
| {297mm}{210mm}% |
| \globaldefs = 0 |
| }} |
| |
| % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH] |
| % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip, |
| % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow. |
| % |
| \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish} |
| \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{% |
| \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi |
| \globaldefs = 1 |
| % |
| \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt |
| \setleading{\textleading}% |
| % |
| \dimen0 = #1\relax |
| \advance\dimen0 by \voffset |
| % |
| \dimen2 = \hsize |
| \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset |
| % |
| \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}% |
| {\voffset}{\normaloffset}% |
| {\bindingoffset}{44pt}% |
| {\dimen0}{\dimen2}% |
| }} |
| |
| % Set default to letter. |
| % |
| \letterpaper |
| |
| |
| \message{and turning on texinfo input format.} |
| |
| \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment |
| |
| % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice. |
| \catcode`\^^? = 14 |
| |
| % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text. |
| \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"} |
| \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix |
| \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+} |
| \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<} |
| \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>} |
| \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^} |
| \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_} |
| \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|} |
| \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~} |
| |
| % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt |
| % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts, |
| % where something hairier probably needs to be done. |
| % |
| % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print |
| % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero |
| % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all |
| % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter. |
| % |
| \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
| |
| % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches |
| % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from |
| % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway |
| % this is not a problem. |
| \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi} |
| |
| % Turn off all special characters except @ |
| % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary). |
| % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can |
| % use math or other variants that look better in normal text. |
| |
| \catcode`\"=\active |
| \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}} |
| \let"=\activedoublequote |
| \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde |
| \chardef\hat=`\^ |
| \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hat}} \let^ = \activehat |
| |
| \catcode`\_=\active |
| \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_} |
| \let\realunder=_ |
| % Subroutine for the previous macro. |
| \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em } |
| |
| \catcode`\|=\active |
| \def|{{\tt\char124}} |
| |
| \chardef \less=`\< |
| \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless |
| \chardef \gtr=`\> |
| \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr |
| \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}} |
| \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix |
| |
| % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page |
| % breaks in the middle of an @tex block. |
| \def\texinfochars{% |
| \let< = \activeless |
| \let> = \activegtr |
| \let~ = \activetilde |
| \let^ = \activehat |
| \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault |
| \let\b = \strong |
| \let\i = \smartitalic |
| % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too. |
| } |
| |
| % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file |
| % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line. |
| % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on. |
| % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file. |
| \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other} |
| |
| % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after |
| % parsing them. |
| \def\turnoffactive{% |
| \normalturnoffactive |
| \otherbackslash |
| } |
| |
| \catcode`\@=0 |
| |
| % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font, |
| % as in \char`\\. |
| \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\ |
| \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work |
| |
| % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and |
| % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines). |
| {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}} |
| |
| % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash |
| % in fixed width font. |
| \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on. |
| |
| % The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont |
| % ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char |
| % in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets |
| % \mathcode`\\="026E). It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always |
| % print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar, |
| % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam; |
| % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the |
| % usual hex value because it has already been made active. |
| @def@normalbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}} |
| @let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents. |
| |
| % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns: |
| % @let \ = @normalbackslash |
| % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont. |
| % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with |
| % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these. |
| @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont} |
| @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash} |
| |
| % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of |
| % the literal character `\'. Also revert - to its normal character, in |
| % case the active - from code has slipped in. |
| % |
| {@catcode`- = @active |
| @gdef@normalturnoffactive{% |
| @let-=@normaldash |
| @let"=@normaldoublequote |
| @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix |
| @let+=@normalplus |
| @let<=@normalless |
| @let>=@normalgreater |
| @let\=@normalbackslash |
| @let^=@normalcaret |
| @let_=@normalunderscore |
| @let|=@normalverticalbar |
| @let~=@normaltilde |
| @markupsetuplqdefault |
| @markupsetuprqdefault |
| @unsepspaces |
| } |
| } |
| |
| % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily. |
| % This is canceled by @fixbackslash. |
| @otherifyactive |
| |
| % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up. |
| % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing |
| % a backslash. |
| % |
| @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash} |
| @global@let\ = @eatinput |
| |
| % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then |
| % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix |
| % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur. |
| % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input |
| % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format. |
| % |
| @gdef@fixbackslash{% |
| @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi |
| @catcode`+=@active |
| @catcode`@_=@active |
| } |
| |
| % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages. |
| @escapechar = `@@ |
| |
| % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need |
| % active definitions as the normal characters. |
| @def@normaldot{.} |
| @def@normalquest{?} |
| @def@normalslash{/} |
| |
| % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special. |
| % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line. |
| @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&} |
| @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#} |
| @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%} |
| |
| @let @hashchar = @normalhash |
| |
| @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and |
| @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we |
| @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars. |
| @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments. |
| @catcode`@'=@active |
| @catcode`@`=@active |
| @markupsetuplqdefault |
| @markupsetuprqdefault |
| |
| @c Local variables: |
| @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp) |
| @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message" |
| @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{" |
| @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H" |
| @c time-stamp-end: "}" |
| @c End: |
| |
| @c vim:sw=2: |
| |
| @ignore |
| arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115 |
| @end ignore |